UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION Washington, D.C. 20549 FORM 10-K ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 Commission file number 0-28839 AUDIOVOX CORPORATION (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) Delaware 13-1964841 (State or other jurisdiction of (I.R.S. Employer incorporation or organization) Identification Number) 150 Marcus Blvd., Hauppauge, New York 11788 (Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code) Registrant's telephone number, including area code (631) 231-7750 Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: Name of Each Exchange on Title of each class: Which Registered Class A Common Stock $.01 par value Nasdaq Stock Market Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirement for the past 90 days. Yes No X ----------- ----- Indicate by check mark whether Registrant is an accelerated filer (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2). Yes X No ----------- ----- Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (Sec 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. -------- 1
The aggregate market value of the common stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant was $168,886,196 (based upon closing price on the Nasdaq Stock Market on May 30, 2003). The number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant's classes of common stock, as of May 23, 2003 was: Class Outstanding ----- ----------- Class A common stock $.01 par value 20,651,374 Class B common stock $.01 par value 2,260,954 2
TABLE OF CONTENTS PART I .........................................................................................................4 Item 1 - Business........................................................................................4 Item 2 - Properties.....................................................................................29 Item 3 - Legal Proceedings..............................................................................29 Item 4 - Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders............................................30 PART II ........................................................................................................31 Item 5 - Market for the Registrant's Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters......................31 Item 6 - Selected Consolidated Financial Data...........................................................31 Item 7 - Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations..........33 Item 7a - Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk....................................67 Item 8 - Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.......................................68 Item 9 - Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure..........145 PART III .......................................................................................................145 Item 10 - Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant...........................................145 Item 11 - Executive Compensation.......................................................................145 Item 12 - Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management...............................150 Item 13 - Certain Relationships and Related Transactions...............................................152 PART IV .......................................................................................................153 Item 14 - Controls and Procedures......................................................................153 Item 15 - Exhibits, Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8...................153 SIGNATURES......................................................................................................158 SCHEDULE II.....................................................................................................160 CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002.........................................161 3
PART I ITEM 1 - BUSINESS All tabular presentation is in thousands unless otherwise indicated. (a) Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002. In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002. These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles. The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows: First Second Third Fiscal Fiscal Quarter Quarter Quarter 2000 2001 2002 2002 2002 ------ ------ ------ ------ ----- (Unaudited) (Unaudited) (Unaudited Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ 263 $1,011 $(1,308) $ (782) $ 751 Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) 263 1,011 (1,308) (782) 751 Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted $0.01 $ 0.05 $ (0.06) $(0.03) $ 0.04 4
The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments: EFFECTS OF RESTATEMENT ADJUSTMENTS ON NET INCOME OR NET LOSS (IN THOUSANDS) Increase (Decrease) (Increase) Decrease Increase (Decrease) in Net Income for the in Net Loss for the in Net Income for the Fiscal Year Ended Fiscal Year Ended Nine Months Ended November 30, 2000 November 30, 2001 August 31, 2002 ----------------- ----------------- ---------------- Unaudited Restatement adjustments: Revenue recognition $ (779) $ 779 - Timing of revenue (15) $ (103) Litigation (373) 427 Foreign currency translation - - (1,491) Inventory pricing - - 420 Sales incentives 1,884 910 847 Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares - - (1,556) Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2) - - - -------------- -------------- ------------- Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss) 1,105 1,301 (1,456) (Provision for) recovery of income taxes (842) (310) 204 Minority interest (1) - 20 (87) --------------- ------------ ------------ Total effect on net income (loss) $ 263 $ 1,011 $ (1,339) =========== ========= ========= (1) This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. (2) This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein. See Note 2, "Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements", of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported fiscal years 2000 and 2001 and Note 26, "Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data- As Restated", of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications. The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment for the corrections of accounting errors. Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited. Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming). The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101 (SAB No. 101), "Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements", which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company. These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000. During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded 5
a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001. Timing of revenue. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers. SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is, in this situation, when the product was delivered to the customer's site). Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer's site. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively. Litigation. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its provisions for certain litigation matters, thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period. Also, the Company understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it. During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim. The Company's insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company. The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful. The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery. Foreign currency translation. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy. In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change. The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income. As a result, the Company understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002. Also the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. Inventory pricing. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary. The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 6
2002 and, accordingly, was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. Sales incentives. During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances) that were not yet offered to its customers. As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively. Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period. As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively. Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares. During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital. This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended May 31, 2002. As a result, the Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556. Income taxes. Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented. The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002. As a result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. Operating expense reclassification. The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included as a component of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales. The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively. The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein. This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. 7
(b) General Development of Business Audiovox was incorporated in Delaware on April 10, 1987, as successor to a business founded in 1960 by John J. Shalam, our President, Chief Executive Officer and controlling stockholder. Its principal executive offices are located at 150 Marcus Boulevard, Hauppauge, New York 11788, and the telephone number is 631-231-7750. The Company designs and markets a diverse line of products and provides related services throughout the world. These products and services include: o handsets and accessories for wireless communications o mobile entertainment and security products o mobile electronic and accessories products and accessories o consumer electronic products and accessories The Company generally markets its products under the well-recognized Audiovox brand name, which it has used for over 38 years. The Company was a pioneer in the wireless industry, selling its first vehicle-installed wireless telephone in 1984 as a natural expansion of its automotive aftermarket products business. The Company's extensive distribution network and its long-standing industry relationships have allowed the Company to benefit from growing market opportunities in the wireless industry and to exploit emerging niches in the consumer electronics business. The Company operates in two primary markets: o Wireless communications. The Wireless Company (Wireless), which accounts for approximately 66% of revenues, sells wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers. o Mobile and consumer electronics. The Electronics Group (Electronics), which accounts for approximately 34% of revenues, sells autosound, mobile video, mobile electronics and consumer electronics through domestic and international distribution channels primarily to mass merchants, power retailers, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEMs), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military. The business grew significantly in fiscal 2000, primarily because of increased sales of digital handsets, as the market continued to shift to digital technology from analog technology. Prior to and including 2000, our wireless business increased as new subscribers came onto the carrier networks as a result of lower price-plans, the shift from analog to digital technologies and the shift from mobile to hand-held portable phones. Since 2000, several factors have affected the Company. New subscriber subscriptions slowed down, the consolidation within our wireless customer base created a more competitive market within a smaller number of customers and there was a slow down in the development of new technologies which slowed consumer demand for one technology to another. The Electronics Group has been positively influenced by an increase in the sale of consumer electronic items such as FRS (Family Radio System) Radios and Mobile Video products. 8
The following table shows net sales by group and the increase in Electronics sales compared to a decrease in Wireless: Percent Change 2000 2001 2002 2000/2002 ---- ---- ---- --------- As Restated (1) As Restated (1) ----------- ----------- (millions) Wireless $1,394 $ 979 $ 727 (47.8)% Electronics 276 298 373 35.1 % -------- -------- -------- ------- Total $1,670 $1,277 $1,100 (34.1)% ====== ====== ====== ======= (1) See Note 2 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. To remain flexible and limit our research and fixed costs, the Company does not manufacture its products. Instead, the Company has relationships with a broad group of suppliers who manufacture its products. The Company works directly with its suppliers in feature design, development and testing of all of its products and performs certain software installations or upgrades for wireless products and some assembly functions for its electronics products. The Company's product development efforts focus on meeting changing consumer demand for technologically-advanced, high-quality products, and the Company consults with customers throughout the design and development process. The Company stands behind all of its products by providing warranties and end-user service support. STRATEGY The Company's objective is to leverage the well-recognized Audiovox brand name and its extensive distribution network to capitalize on the growing worldwide demand for wireless products and continue to provide innovative mobile and consumer electronics products in response to consumer demand. The key elements of the Company's strategy are: Enhance and capitalize on the Audiovox brand name. The Company believes that the "Audiovox" brand name is one of its greatest strengths. During the past 38 years, the Company has invested to establish the Audiovox name as a well-known consumer brand for communications and electronics products. The Company's wireless handsets generally bear the Audiovox brand name or are co-branded with either a wireless carrier or brand name of our supplier. To further benefit from the Audiovox name, the Company continues to introduce new products using its brand name and licenses its brand name for selected consumer products. Expand wireless technology offerings to increase market opportunities. The Company intends to continue to offer an array of technologically-advanced wireless products, including the planned introduction of wireless handsets with cameras and enhanced Internet capabilities. The Company's wide selection of wireless products will allow it to satisfy different carrier demands, both domestically and internationally. 9
Capitalize on niche market opportunities in the consumer electronics industry. The Company intends to continue to use its extensive distribution and supply networks to capitalize on niche market opportunities, such as navigation, mobile video, DVD's and cruise controls, in the consumer electronics industry. The Company believes that focusing on high-demand, high-growth niche products results in better profit margins and growth potential for its electronics business. Continue to expand international presence. During fiscal 2003, the Company intends to continue to expand its international business, both in the Wireless and Electronics Groups, as it plans to introduce new products compatible with international wireless technologies, such as GSM, CDMA and GPRS and expand the mobile video category. Continue to outsource manufacturing to increase operating leverage. One of the key components of the Company's business strategy is outsourcing the manufacturing of its products. This allows the Company to deliver the latest technological advances without the fixed costs associated with manufacturing. Continue to provide value-added services to customers and suppliers. The Company believes that it provides key services, such as product design, development and testing, sales support, product repair and warranty and software upgrading, more efficiently than its customers and suppliers could provide for themselves. The Company intends to continue to develop its value- added services as the market evolves and customer needs change. (c) Financial Information About Industry Segments The Company's industry segments are the Wireless Group and the Electronics Group. Net sales, income before provision for income taxes and total assets attributable to each segment for each of the last three years are set forth in Note 23 of the Company's consolidated financial statements included herein. (d) Narrative Description of Business WIRELESS Wireless, which accounts for approximately 66% of the Company's revenues, markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers. WIRELESS PRODUCTS AND TECHNOLOGY Wireless sells an array of digital handsets, hand-held computing devices and accessories in a variety of technologies, principally CDMA. In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002 digital products represented 78%, 89% and 96%, respectively, of Wireless' total unit sales. Wireless generally markets its wireless products under the Audiovox brand name or co-brands its products with its carrier customers, such as Verizon Wireless and Bell Distribution, Inc. or with the brand name of the supplier. In addition to handsets, Wireless sells a complete line of accessories that includes batteries, hands-free kits, battery eliminators, cases and data cables. In fiscal 2003, Wireless intends to continue 10
to broaden its digital product offerings and introduce handsets with new features such as wireless handsets with cameras and enhanced Internet capabilities. WIRELESS MARKETING AND DISTRIBUTION Wireless sells wireless products to wireless carriers and the carrier's respective agents, distributors and retailers. In addition, a majority of its handsets are designed to meet carrier specifications. In fiscal 2000, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, AllTel Communications, MCI Worldcom, Brightpoint, Inc. and Canadian Mobility. One of these customers accounted for 61.7% of Wireless' net sales for fiscal 2000 and 50.5% of the 2000 consolidated net sales. In fiscal 2001, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, PrimeCo Personal Communications LP, Sprint Spectrum LP, Bell Distribution Inc. and Brightpoint, Inc. One of these customers accounted for 44.8% of Wireless' net sales and 35.0% of consolidated net sales for fiscal 2001. In fiscal 2002, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, Bell Distribution, Inc., Sprint Spectrum LP, Telus Mobility and AllTel Communications. Three of these customers accounted for 36%, 11% and 10%, respectively, of Wireless' net sales for fiscal 2002. All of these customers represented 71% of Wireless' net sales and 47% of consolidated net sales during fiscal 2002. In addition, Wireless promotes its products through trade and consumer advertising, participation at trade shows and direct personal contact by its sales representatives. Wireless also assists wireless carriers with their marketing campaigns by scripting telemarketing presentations, funding co-operative advertising campaigns, developing and printing custom sales literature, logistic services, conducting in-house training programs for wireless carriers and their agents and providing assistance in market development. Wireless operates approximately seven retail facilities under the name Quintex. In addition, Wireless licenses the trade name Quintex(R) to ten outlets in selected markets in the United States. Wireless also serves as an agent (in activating cell phone numbers) for the following carriers in selected areas: Tmobile, Nextel, Suncom, NTelos, AT & T Wireless, Verizon Wireless, Sprint and Sprint Spectrum LP. For fiscal 2002, revenues from Quintex were 6.1% of total Wireless revenues and 4.1% of consolidated revenues. Wireless' policy is to ship its products within 24 hours of a requested shipment date from public warehouses in Florida, New York, California , New Jersey, Canada and Netherlands and from leased facilities located in New York and California. WIRELESS PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT, WARRANTY AND CUSTOMER SERVICE Although Wireless does not have its own manufacturing facilities, it works closely with both customers and suppliers in feature design, development and testing of its products. In particular, Wireless: o with its wireless customers, determines future market feature requirements o works with its suppliers to develop products containing those features o participates in the design of the features and cosmetics of its wireless products o tests products in its own facilities to ensure compliance with Audiovox standards o supervises testing of the products in its carrier markets to ensure compliance with carrier specifications 11
Wireless' Hauppauge facility is ISO-9001:1994 certified, which requires it to carefully monitor quality standards in all facets of its business. Wireless believes customer service is an important tool for enhancing its brand name and its relationship with carriers. In order to provide full service to its customers, Wireless warranties its wireless products to the end-user for periods ranging from up to one year for portable handsets to up to three years for mobile car phones. To support its warranties, Wireless has approximately 1,950 independent warranty centers throughout the United States and Canada and has experienced technicians in its warranty repair stations at its headquarters facility. Wireless has experienced customer service representatives who interact directly with both end-users and its customers. These representatives are trained to respond to questions on handset operation and warranty and repair issues. WIRELESS SUPPLIERS Wireless purchases its wireless products from several manufacturers located in Pacific Rim countries, including Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia. In selecting its suppliers, Wireless considers quality, price, service, market conditions and reputation. Wireless generally purchases its products under short-term purchase orders and does not enter into long-term contracts with its suppliers. Wireless considers its relations with its suppliers to be good. Wireless believes that alternative sources of supply are currently available, although there could be a time lag and increased costs if it were to have an unplanned shift to a new supplier. Approximately 56% of Wireless' 2002 purchases were from Toshiba, a related party (see Related Party Transaction of Item 7 - Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.) WIRELESS COMPETITION The market for wireless handsets and accessories is highly competitive and is characterized by intense price competition, significant price erosion over the life of a product whose life cycle has continued to shorten, demand for value-added services, rapid technological development and industry consolidation of both customers and manufacturers. Currently, Wireless' primary competitors for wireless handsets include Motorola, Nokia, Kyocera and Samsung. Wireless also competes with numerous established and new manufacturers and distributors, some of whom sell the same or similar products directly to its customers. Historically, Wireless' competitors have also included some of its own suppliers and customers. Many of Wireless' competitors offer more extensive advertising and promotional programs than it does. Wireless competes for sales to carriers, agents and distributors on the basis of its products and services and price. As its customers are requiring greater value-added logistic services, Wireless believes that competition will continually be required to support an infrastructure capable of providing these services. Wireless' ability to continue to compete successfully will largely depend on its ability to perform these value-added services at a reasonable cost. Wireless' products compete primarily on the basis of value in terms of price, features and reliability. There have been, and will continue to be, several periods of extreme price competition in the wireless industry, particularly when one or more or its competitors has sought to sell off excess inventory by 12
lowering its prices significantly or carriers canceling or modifying sales programs. As a result of global competitive pressures, there have been significant consolidations in the domestic wireless industry including: o Cricket and Leap Wireless o Verizon Wireless: Bell Atlantic, AirTouch Communications, GTE Mobilnet, PrimeCo Personal Communications LP, Frontier, Ameritech and Vodafone o Cingular Wireless: SBC Communications and Bell South o VoiceStream: Expanded into major markets through acquisition of Omnipoint o Telus and Clearnet These consolidations may result in greater competition for a smaller number of large customers and may favor one or more of its competitors over Wireless. ELECTRONICS GROUP ELECTRONICS INDUSTRY The mobile and consumer electronics industry is large and diverse and encompasses a broad range of products. There are many large manufacturers in the industry, such as Sony, RCA, Panasonic, Kenwood, Motorola and JVC, as well as large companies that specialize in niche products. The Electronics Group participates in selected niche markets such as autosound, mobile video, vehicle security and selected consumer electronics. The introduction of new products and technological advancements drives growth in the electronics industry. For example, the transition from analog to digital technology is leading to the development of a new generation of consumer electronic products. Some of these products include digital satellite radio, portable DVD, home and mobile video systems, navigation systems and FRS radios. ELECTRONICS PRODUCTS The Company's electronics products consist of two major categories, mobile electronics and consumer electronics. Mobile electronics products include: o autosound products, such as radios, speakers, amplifiers, CD changers and satellite radios o mobile video products, including overhead and center console mobile entertainment systems, video cassette players and DVD players o automotive security and remote start systems o automotive power accessories o navigation systems Consumer electronics include: o home and portable stereos 13
o FRS two-way radios o LCD televisions The Electronics Group markets its products under the Audiovox(R) brand name, as well as several other Audiovox-owned trade names that include Prestige(R), Pursuit(R) and Rampage(TM) and Code Systems, Inc. Sales by the Company's Malaysian, Venezuelan and American Radio subsidiaries fall under the Electronics Group. For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Electronics Group's sales by product category were as follows: Percent Change 2000 2001 2002 2000/2002 ---- ---- ---- --------- (millions) (As Restate (As Restated) Mobile electronics $134.6 $157.7 $229.3 70.4% Sound 77.4 57.5 56.3 (27.3) Consumer electronics 60.5 80.3 86.5 43.0 Other 3.9 2.2 0.6 (82.1) ------ ------ ------ ------- Total $276.4 $297.7 $372.7 34.9% ====== ====== ====== ======= The increase in Electronic's sales reflects new product introductions in the mobile and consumer electronics categories and a continuing trend in lower sound sales as automakers incorporate full-featured sound systems at the factory instead of as an aftermarket option. In the future, the Electronics Group will continue to focus its efforts on new technologies to take advantage of market opportunities created by the digital convergence of data, communications, navigation and entertainment products. LICENSING In the late 1990's, the Company began to license its brand name for use on selected products, such as home and portable stereo systems. Actual sales of licensed products are not included in the Company's sales figures. However, licensed customers have reported sales of $43.6 million in licensed goods in 2002 compared to $24.0 million in 2001 for which the Company received license fees. License sales promote the Audiovox brand name without adding any significant costs. License fees are recognized on a per unit basis upon sale to the end-user and are recorded in other income. License fees in 2002 approximated $922 compared to approximately $500 in 2001. ELECTRONICS DISTRIBUTION AND MARKETING The Electronics Group sells its electronics products to: o mass merchants o chain stores o specialty retailers o distributors o new car dealers 14
o the U.S. military The Electronics Group also sells its products under OEM arrangements with domestic and/or international subsidiaries of automobile manufacturers such as Ford Corporation, Daimler Chrysler, General Motors Corporation and Nissan. OEM projects represent a significant portion of the Electronics Group sales, accounting for approximately 14.0% of the Electronics Group's sales in 2002 versus 17.1% in 2001. These projects require a close partnership with the customer as the Electronics Group develops products to their specific requirements. Three of the largest auto makers, General Motors, Daimler Chrysler and Ford require QS registration for all of their vendors. The Electronics Group's Hauppauge facility is both QS 9000 and ISO 9001 registered. In addition, Audiovox Electronics is Q1 rated for the Ford Motor Company. In fiscal 2000, the Electronics Group's five largest customers were Nissan, Wal-Mart, Target, Gulf States Toyota and Circuit City. They represented 21.3% of the Electronics Group's net sales and 3.5% of consolidated net sales. In fiscal 2001, the Electronics Group's five largest customers were Wal-Mart, Target, Ford, KMart and Circuit City. They represented 27.0% of the Electronics Group's net sales and 6.3% of consolidated net sales. In fiscal 2002, the Electronics Group's five largest customers were Circuit City, Target, Walmart, Sam's Wholesale Club and Gulf States Toyota. They represented 25% of the Electronics Group's net sales and 8% of the consolidated net sales. As part of the Electronics Group's sales process, the Electronics Group provides value-added management services including: o product design and development o engineering and testing o technical and sales support o electronic data interchange (EDI) o product repair services and warranty o nationwide installation network The Electronics Group has flexible shipping policies designed to meet customer needs. In the absence of specific customer instructions, the Electronics Group ships its products within 24 to 48 hours from the receipt of an order. The Electronics Group makes shipments from public warehouses in Virginia, Nevada, Florida, New Jersey, California and Venezuela and from leased facilities located in New York. ELECTRONICS PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT, WARRANTY AND CUSTOMER SERVICE The Electronics Group works closely with its customers and suppliers in the design, development and testing of its products. For the Electronics Group's OEM automobile customers, the Electronics Group performs extensive validation testing to ensure that its products meet the special environmental and electronic standards of the manufacturer. The Electronics Group also performs final assembly of products in its Hauppauge location. The Electronics Group's product development cycle includes: o working with key customers and suppliers to identify consumer trends and potential demand o working with the suppliers to design and develop products to meet those demands o evaluating and testing the products in our own facilities to ensure compliance with our 15
standards o performing software design and validation testing The Electronics Group provides a warranty to the end-users of its electronics products, generally ranging from 90 days up to the life of the vehicle for the original owner on some of its automobile-installed products. To support its warranties, the Electronics Group has independent warranty centers throughout the United States, Canada, Venezuela and Malaysia. At its Hauppauge facility, the Electronics Group has a customer service group that provides product information, answers questions and serves as a technical hotline for installation help for both end-users and its customers. The Electronics Group Hauppauge facility is QS-9000:1998 / ISO-9001:1994 certified, which requires it to carefully monitor quality standards in all facets of its business. ELECTRONICS SUPPLIERS The Electronics Group purchases its electronics products from manufacturers located in several Pacific Rim countries, including Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan, Singapore and Malaysia. The Electronics Group also uses several manufacturers in the United States for cruise controls, mobile video and power amplifiers. In selecting its manufacturers, the Electronics Group considers quality, price, service, market conditions and reputation. The Electronics Group maintains buying offices or inspection offices in Taiwan, South Korea, China and Hong Kong to provide local supervision of supplier performance such as price negotiations, delivery and quality control. The Electronics Group generally purchases its products under short-term purchase orders and does not have long-term contracts with its suppliers. The Electronics Group believes that alternative sources of supply are currently available, although there could be a time lag and increased costs if it were to have an unplanned shift to a new supplier. The Electronics Group considers relations with its suppliers to be good. In addition, the Electronics Group believes that alternative sources of supply are generally available within 120 days. ELECTRONICS COMPETITION The Electronics Group's business is highly competitive across all of its product lines and competes with a number of well-established companies that manufacture and sell similar products. The Electronics Group's mobile electronics products compete against factory-supplied radios (including General Motors, Ford and Daimler Chrysler), security and mobile video systems . The Electronics Group's mobile electronics products also compete in the automotive aftermarket against major companies such as Sony, Panasonic, Kenwood, Motorola and Pioneer. The Electronics Group's consumer electronics product lines compete against major consumer electronic companies, such as JVC, Sony, Panasonic, Motorola, RCA and AIWA. Brand name, design, features and price are the major competitive factors across all of its product lines. (e) Financial Information About Foreign and Domestic Operations and Export Sales The amounts of net sales and long-lived assets, attributable to each of the Company's geographic segments for each of the last three fiscal years are set forth in Note 23 to the Company's consolidated financial statements included herein. During fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company exported 16
approximately $246, $215 and $233 million, respectively, in product sales. TRADEMARKS The Company markets products under several trademarks, including Audiovox(R), Prestige(R), Pursuit(R) and Rampage(TM) . The trademark Audiovox(R) is registered in approximately 67 countries. The Company believes that these trademarks are recognized by customers and are therefore significant in marketing its products. OTHER MATTERS EQUITY INVESTMENTS The Company has investments in unconsolidated joint ventures which were formed to market its products in specific market segments or geographic areas. The Company seeks to blend its financial and product resources with local operations to expand its distribution and marketing capabilities. The Company believes its joint ventures provide a more cost-effective method of focusing on specialized markets. The Company does not participate in the day-to-day management of these joint ventures. The Company's significant joint ventures are: Percentage Formation Venture Ownership Date Function ------- --------- --------- -------- Audiovox Specialized Distribution of products for van, RV Applications 50.0% 1997 and other specialized vehicles. Bliss-Tel Company, Ltd. 20.0% 1997 Distribution of wireless products and accessories in Thailand. EMPLOYEES The Company employs approximately 1,000 people. The Company's headcount has been relatively stable for the past several years, but will change based upon economic conditions within the two groups. The Company considers its relations with its employees to be good. No employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements. 17
DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT The directors and executive officers of the Company are listed below. All officers of the Company are elected by the Board of Directors to serve one-year terms. There are no family relationships among officers, or any arrangement or understanding between any officer and any other person pursuant to which the officer was selected. Unless otherwise indicated, positions listed in the table have been held for more than five years. Name Age Current Position - ---- --- ---------------- John J. Shalam 69 President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors Philip Christopher 54 Executive Vice President and a Director Charles M. Stoehr 56 Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and a Director Patrick M. Lavelle 51 Senior Vice President and a Director Ann M. Boutcher 52 Vice President, Marketing and a Director Richard A. Maddia 44 Vice President, IS and a Director Paul C. Kreuch, Jr.* 64 Director Dennis F. McManus* 52 Director Irving Halevy* 86 Director *Member of the Audit and Compensation Committees John J. Shalam has served as President, Chief Executive Officer and as Director of Audiovox or its predecessor since 1960. Mr. Shalam also serves as President and a Director of most of Audiovox's operating subsidiaries. Mr.Shalam is on the Board of Directors of the Electronics Industry Association and is on the Executive Committee of the Consumer Electronics Association. Philip Christopher, our Executive Vice President, has been with Audiovox since 1970 and has held his current position since 1983. Before 1983, he served as Senior Vice President of Audiovox. Mr. Christopher is Chief Executive Officer of Audiovox's wireless subsidiary, Audiovox Communications Corp. From 1973 through 1987, he was a Director of our predecessor, Audiovox Corp. Mr. Christopher serves on the Executive Committee of the Cellular Telephone Industry Association. Charles M. Stoehr has been our Chief Financial Officer since 1979 and was elected Senior Vice President in 1990. Mr. Stoehr has been a Director of Audiovox since 1987. From 1979 through 1990, he was a Vice President of Audiovox. 18
Patrick M. Lavelle has been a Vice President of the Company since 1980 and was appointed Senior Vice President in 1991. He was elected to the Board of Directors in 1993. Mr. Lavelle is Chief Executive Officer and President of the Company's subsidiary, Audiovox Electronics Corp. Mr. Lavelle is also a member of the Board of Directors and Executive Committee of the Consumer Electronics Association and serves as Chairmen of its Mobile Electronics Division. Ann M. Boutcher has been our Vice President of Marketing since 1984. Ms. Boutcher's responsibilities include the development and implementation of our advertising, sales promotion and public relations programs. Ms. Boutcher was elected to the Board of Directors in 1995. Richard A. Maddia has been our Vice President of Information Systems since 1992. Prior thereto, Mr. Maddia was Assistant Vice President, MIS. Mr. Maddia's responsibilities include development and maintenance of information systems. Mr. Maddia was elected to the Board of Directors in 1996. Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. was elected to the Board of Directors in February 1997. Mr. Kreuch is a Managing Director of WJM Associates, Inc., a leading executive development firm. Prior career responsibilities include Executive Vice President of NatWest Bank, N.A. from 1993 to 1996, and, before that, President of National Westminster Bank, USA. Dennis F. McManus was elected to the Board of Directors in March 1998. Mr. McManus is currently the Vice President - New Product Marketing at the LSSi Corporation. Prior to that Mr. McManus had been self-employed as a telecommunications consultant. Before that, he was employed by NYNEX Corp. for over 27 years, most recently as a Senior Vice President and Managing Director. Mr. McManus held this position from 1991 through December 31, 1997. Irving Halevy served on the Board of Directors from 1987 to 1997 and was re-elected to the Board of Directors in 2001. Mr. Halevy is a retired professor of Industrial Relations and Management at Fairleigh Dickinson University where he taught from 1952 to 1986. He was also a panel member of the Federal Mediation and Conciliation Service. All of our executive officers hold office at the discretion of the Board of Directors. CAUTIONARY FACTORS THAT MAY AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS We have identified certain risk factors that apply to either Audiovox as a whole or one of our specific business units. You should carefully consider each of the following risk factors and all of the other information included or incorporated by reference in this Form 10-K. If any of these risks, or other risks not presently known to us or that we currently believe not to be significant, develop into actual events, then our business, financial condition, liquidity, or results of operations could be materially adversely affected. If that happens, the market price of our common stock would likely decline, and you may lose all or part of your investment. WE MAY NOT BE ABLE TO COMPETE SUCCESSFULLY IN THE HIGHLY COMPETITIVE WIRELESS INDUSTRY. The market for wireless handsets and accessories is highly competitive and is characterized by: 19
o intense price competition o shorter product life cycles o significant price erosion over the life of a product o industry consolidation o rapid technological development o the demand by wireless carriers for value-added services provided by their suppliers Our primary competitors for wireless handsets currently are Motorola, Nokia, Kyocera and Samsung. In addition, we compete with numerous other established and new manufacturers and distributors, some of whom sell the same or similar products directly to our customers. Historically, our competitors have also included some of our own suppliers and customers. Many of our competitors offer more extensive advertising and promotional programs than we do. During the last decade, there have been several periods of extreme price competition, particularly when one or more or our competitors has sought to sell off excess inventory by lowering its prices significantly. In particular, when technologies changed in 2000 from analog to digital, several of our larger competitors lowered their prices significantly to reduce their inventories, which required us to similarly reduce our prices. These price reductions had a material adverse effect on our profitability. There can be no assurance that our competitors will not do this again, because, among other reasons, many of them have significantly greater financial resources than we do and can withstand substantial price competition. Since we sell products that tend to have low gross profit-margins, price competition has had, and may in the future have, a material adverse effect on our financial performance. THE ELECTRONICS BUSINESS IS HIGHLY COMPETITIVE; OUR ELECTRONICS BUSINESS ALSO FACES SIGNIFICANT COMPETITION FROM ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT MANUFACTURERS (OEMS). The market for electronics is highly competitive across all three of our product lines. We compete against many established companies who have substantially greater resources than us. In addition, we compete directly with OEMs, including divisions of well-known automobile manufacturers, in the autosound, auto security, mobile video and accessories industry. Most of these companies have substantially greater financial and other resources than we do. We believe that OEMs have increased sales pressure on new car dealers with whom they have close business relationships to purchase OEM-supplied equipment and accessories. OEMs have also diversified and improved their product lines and accessories in an effort to increase sales of their products. To the extent that OEMs succeed in their efforts, this success would have a material adverse effect on our sales of automotive entertainment and security products to new car dealers. WIRELESS CARRIERS AND SUPPLIERS MAY NOT CONTINUE TO OUTSOURCE VALUE-ADDED SERVICES; WE MAY NOT BE ABLE TO CONTINUE TO PROVIDE COMPETITIVE VALUE-ADDED SERVICES. Wireless carriers purchase from us, rather than directly from our suppliers, because, among other reasons, we provide added services valued by our customers. In order to maintain our sales levels, we must continue to provide these value-added services at reasonable costs to our carrier-customers and suppliers, including: o product sourcing 20
o product distribution o marketing o custom packaging o warranty support o programming wireless handsets o testing for carrier system acceptance Our success depends on the wireless equipment manufacturers, wireless carriers, network operators and resellers continuing to outsource these functions rather than performing them in-house. To encourage the use of our services, we must keep our prices reasonable. If our internal costs of supplying these services increase, we may not be able to raise our prices to pass these costs along to our customers and suppliers. As a result of the consolidations in the telecommunications industry, wireless carriers, which are the largest customers of our wireless business, may attempt to perform these services themselves. Alternatively, our customers and suppliers may transact business directly with each other rather than through us. If our customers or suppliers begin to perform these services internally or do business directly with each other, it could have a material adverse effect on our sales and our profits. OUR SUCCESS DEPENDS ON OUR ABILITY TO KEEP PACE WITH TECHNOLOGICAL ADVANCES IN THE WIRELESS INDUSTRY. Rapid technological change and frequent new product introductions characterize the wireless product market. Our success depends upon our ability to: o identify the new products necessary to meet the demands of the wireless marketplace and o locate suppliers who are able to manufacture those products on a timely and cost-effective basis. As a result of the emergence of the digital market, which resulted in the reduction of selling prices of analog hand-held phones, we recorded analog inventory write-downs to market of $8.2 million and $13.5 million in 2000 and 2001, respectively. These write-downs had a material adverse effect on our profitability. As a result of increasing pricing pressures and a surplus of supply created by other manufacturers also attempting to sell off analog inventories, there was a drop off in demand for analog products. The write down was based upon the drop in demand, as carriers no longer promoted analog product and notified the Company that previous indications for orders of analog phones were no longer viable. Also during 2001, the Company recorded an additional inventory write-down to market of $7,150 associated with older digital products as newer products were being introduced. During 2002, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs totaling of $13,823 pertaining to its digital inventory due to more current technological advances in the market. This write-down was made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations. There can be no assurance that this will not occur again given the emergence of new technologies. Since we do not make any of our own products and do not conduct our own research, we cannot assure you that we will be able to source the products that advances in technology require to remain competitive. Furthermore, the introduction or expected introduction of new products or technologies may depress sales of existing products and technologies. This may result in declining prices and inventory 21
obsolescence. Since we maintain a substantial investment in product inventory, declining prices and inventory obsolescence could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. (See further discussions in Business Overview Page 37). WE DEPEND ON A SMALL NUMBER OF KEY CUSTOMERS FOR A LARGE PERCENTAGE OF OUR SALES. The wireless industry is characterized by a small number of key customers. In fiscal 2000, 75% of our wireless sales were to five customers, and for 2001 70% of our wireless sales were to five customers. Our five largest customers accounted for 71% of our wireless sales in fiscal 2002, one of which accounted for 36% of our wireless sales in fiscal 2002. The loss of one or more of these customers would have a material impact on our business. WE DO NOT HAVE LONG-TERM SALES CONTRACTS WITH ANY OF OUR CUSTOMERS. Sales of our wireless products are made by written purchase orders and are terminable at will by either party. The unexpected loss of all or a significant portion of sales to any one of our large customers could have a material adverse effect on our performance. Sales of our electronics products are made by purchase order and are terminated at will at the option of either party. We do not have long-term sales contracts with any of our customers. The unexpected loss of all or a significant portion of sales to any one of these customers could result in a material adverse effect on our performance. WE COULD LOSE CUSTOMERS OR ORDERS AS A RESULT OF CONSOLIDATION IN THE WIRELESS TELECOMMUNICATIONS CARRIER INDUSTRY. As a result of global competitive pressures, there has been significant consolidation in the domestic wireless industry: o Cricket and Leap Wireless o Verizon Wireless: Bell Atlantic, AirTouch Communications, GTE Mobilnet, Prime Co Personal Communications LP, Frontier, Ameritech and Vodafone o Cingular Wireless: SBC Communications and Bell South o VoiceStream: Expanded into major markets through acquisition of Omnipoint o Telus and Clearnet Future consolidations could cause us to lose business if any of the new consolidated entities do not perform as they expect to because of integration or other problems. In addition, these consolidations will result in a smaller number of wireless carriers, leading to greater competition in the wireless handset market and may favor one or more of our competitors over us. This could also lead to fluctuations in our quarterly results and carrying value of our inventory. If any of these new entities orders less product from us or elects not to do business with us or changes current pricing in order to compete, it would have a material adverse effect on our business. In fiscal 2002, the five largest wireless customers were Verizon Wireless, Bell Distribution, Inc., Sprint Spectrum LP, Telus Mobility and AllTel Communications. Three customers each accounted for 36%, 11% and 10%, respectively, of Wireless' net sales for fiscal 2002. All of these customers represented 71% of Wireless' net sales and 47% of consolidated net sales during fiscal 2002. 22
SALES IN OUR ELECTRONICS BUSINESS ARE DEPENDENT ON NEW PRODUCTS AND CONSUMER ACCEPTANCE. Our electronics business depends, to a large extent, on the introduction and availability of innovative products and technologies. Significant sales of new products in niche markets, such as FRS two-way radios, known as FRS radios, portable DVD players and mobile video systems, have fueled the recent growth of our electronics business. If we are not able to continually introduce new products that achieve consumer acceptance, our sales and profit margins will decline. SINCE WE DO NOT MANUFACTURE OUR PRODUCTS, WE DEPEND ON OUR SUPPLIERS TO PROVIDE US WITH ADEQUATE QUANTITIES OF HIGH QUALITY COMPETITIVE PRODUCTS ON A TIMELY BASIS. We do not manufacture our products. We do not have long-term contracts but have exclusive distribution arrangements with certain suppliers. The suppliers can only sell their products through the Company for a given geographic or designated market area. Most of our products are imported from suppliers under short-term purchase orders. Accordingly, we can give no assurance that: o our supplier relationships will continue as presently in effect o our suppliers will be able to obtain the components necessary to produce high-quality, technologically-advanced products for us o we will be able to obtain adequate alternatives to our supply sources should they be interrupted o if obtained, alternatively sourced products of satisfactory quality would be delivered on a timely basis, competitively priced, comparably featured or acceptable to our customers o exclusive geographic or market area distribution agreements will be renewed Because of the increased demand for wireless and consumer electronics products, there have been, and still could be, industry-wide shortages of components. As a result, our suppliers have not been able to produce the quantities of these products that we desire. Our inability to supply sufficient quantities of products that are in demand could reduce our profitability and have a material adverse effect on our relationships with our customers. If any of our supplier relationships were terminated or interrupted, we could experience an immediate or long-term supply shortage, which could have a material adverse effect on us. It is likely that our supply of wireless products would be interrupted before we could obtain alternative products. BECAUSE WE PURCHASE A SIGNIFICANT AMOUNT OF OUR PRODUCTS FROM SUPPLIERS IN PACIFIC RIM COUNTRIES, WE ARE SUBJECT TO THE ECONOMIC RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH CHANGES IN THE SOCIAL, POLITICAL, REGULATORY AND ECONOMIC CONDITIONS INHERENT IN THESE COUNTRIES. We import most of our products from suppliers in the Pacific Rim. Countries in the Pacific Rim have experienced significant social, political and economic upheaval over the past several years. Because of the large concentrations of our purchases in Pacific Rim countries, particularly Japan, China, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia, any adverse changes in the social, political, regulatory and economic conditions in these countries may materially increase the cost of the products that we buy from our foreign suppliers or delay shipments of products, which could have a material adverse effect on our business. In addition, our dependence on foreign suppliers forces us to order products further in advance than we would if our products were manufactured domestically. This increases the risk that our products will become obsolete or face selling price reductions before we can sell our inventory. 23
WE PLAN TO EXPAND THE INTERNATIONAL MARKETING AND DISTRIBUTION OF OUR PRODUCTS, WHICH WILL SUBJECT US TO ADDITIONAL BUSINESS RISKS. As part of our business strategy, we intend to increase our international sales, although we cannot assure you that we will be able to do so. Conducting business outside of the United States subjects us to significant additional risks, including: o export and import restrictions, tax consequences and other trade barriers o currency fluctuations o greater difficulty in accounts receivable collections o economic and political instability o foreign exchange controls that prohibit payment in U.S. dollars o increased complexity and costs of managing and staffing international operations For instance, our international sales have been affected by political unrest and currency fluctuation in Venezuela. Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. FLUCTUATIONS IN FOREIGN CURRENCIES COULD HAVE A MATERIAL ADVERSE IMPACT ON OUR BUSINESS. We cannot predict the effect of exchange rate fluctuations on our future operating results. Also, due to the short-term nature of our supply arrangements, the relationship of the U.S. dollar to foreign currencies will impact price quotes when negotiating new supply arrangements denominated in U.S. dollars. As a result, we could experience declining selling prices in our market without the benefit of cost decreases on purchases from suppliers or we could experience increasing costs without an ability to pass the costs to the customers. We cannot assure you that we will be able to effectively limit our exposure to foreign currencies. Foreign currency fluctuations could cause our operating results to decline and have a material adverse effect on our ability to compete. Many of our competitors manufacture products in the United States or outside the Pacific Rim, which could place us at a competitive disadvantage if the value of the Pacific Rim currencies increased relative to the currency in the countries where our competitors obtain their products. TRADE SANCTIONS AGAINST FOREIGN COUNTRIES OR FOREIGN COMPANIES COULD HAVE A MATERIAL ADVERSE IMPACT ON OUR BUSINESS. As a result of trade disputes, the United States and foreign countries have occasionally imposed tariffs, regulatory procedures and importation bans on certain products, including wireless handsets that have been produced in foreign countries. Trade sanctions or regulatory procedures involving a country in which we conduct a substantial amount of business could have a material adverse effect on our operations. Some of the countries we purchase products from are: China, Japan, South Korea, Taiwan and Malaysia. China and Japan have been affected by such sanctions in the past. In addition, the United States has imposed, and may in the future impose, sanctions on foreign companies for anti-dumping and other violations of U.S. law. If sanctions were imposed on any of our suppliers or customers, it could have a material adverse effect on our operations. 24
WE MAY NOT BE ABLE TO SUSTAIN OUR RECENT GROWTH RATES OR MAINTAIN PROFIT MARGINS. Sales of our wireless products, a large portion of our business that operates on a high-volume, low-margin basis, have varied significantly over the past several years, from approximately $423 million in fiscal 1998 to approximately $1.4 billion for fiscal 2000 back to approximately $727 million in 2002. Sales of our electronics products also increased significantly from approximately $182 million for fiscal 1998 to approximately $373 million for fiscal 2002. We may not be able to continue to achieve this overall revenue growth rate or maintain profit margins because, among other reasons, of increased competition and technological changes. This can be seen in the decline of our Wireless Group during 2000 from the changeover from analog to digital. In addition, we expect that our operating expenses will continue to increase as we seek to expand our business, which could also result in a reduction in profit margins if we do not concurrently increase our sales proportionately. IF OUR SALES DURING THE HOLIDAY SEASON FALL BELOW OUR EXPECTATIONS, OUR ANNUAL RESULTS COULD ALSO FALL BELOW EXPECTATIONS. Seasonal consumer shopping patterns significantly affect our business. We generally make a substantial amount of our sales and net income during September, October and November, our fourth fiscal quarter. We expect this trend to continue. December is also a key month for us, due largely to the increase in promotional activities by our customers during the holiday season. If the economy faltered in these periods, if our customers altered the timing or frequency of their promotional activities or if the effectiveness of these promotional activities declined, particularly around the holiday season, it could have a material adverse effect on our annual financial results. A DECLINE IN GENERAL ECONOMIC CONDITIONS COULD LEAD TO REDUCED CONSUMER DEMAND FOR THE DISCRETIONARY PRODUCTS WE SELL. Consumer spending patterns, especially discretionary spending for products such as consumer electronics and wireless handsets, are affected by, among other things, prevailing economic conditions, wage rates, inflation, consumer confidence and consumer perception of economic conditions. A general slowdown in the U.S. economy or an uncertain economic outlook could have a material adverse effect on our sales. So far, the recent economic slowdown has not materially affected our business. In addition, our mobile electronics business is dependent on the level of car sales in our markets. WE DEPEND HEAVILY ON EXISTING MANAGEMENT AND KEY PERSONNEL AND OUR ABILITY TO RECRUIT AND RETAIN QUALIFIED PERSONNEL. Our success depends on the continued efforts of John J. Shalam, Philip Christopher, C. Michael Stoehr and Patrick Lavelle, each of whom has worked with Audiovox for over two decades, as well as our other executive officers and key employees. We only have one employment contract, with Philip Christopher and none with any other executive officers or key employees. The loss or interruption of the continued full-time service of certain of our executive officers and key employees could have a material adverse effect on our business. In addition, to support our continued growth, we must effectively recruit, develop and retain additional qualified personnel both domestically and internationally. Our inability to attract and retain necessary qualified personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business. 25
WE ARE RESPONSIBLE FOR PRODUCT WARRANTIES AND DEFECTS. Even though we outsource manufacturing, we provide warranties for all of our products for which we have provided an estimated liability. Therefore, we are highly dependent on the quality of our suppliers. The warranties for our electronics products range from 90 days to the lifetime of a vehicle for the original owner. The warranties for our wireless products generally range from one to three years. In addition, if we are required to repair a significant amount of product, the value of the product could decline while we are repairing the product. In particular, in 1998, a software problem caused us to recall a specific line of analog handsets. After a $1 million reimbursement from the manufacturer for warranty costs, this recall resulted in a net pre-tax charge of $6.6 million to cover the decline in the selling price of the product during the period we were repairing the handsets. We cannot assure you that we will not have similar problems in the future. OUR CAPITAL RESOURCES MAY NOT BE SUFFICIENT TO MEET OUR FUTURE CAPITAL AND LIQUIDITY REQUIREMENTS. We believe that we currently have sufficient resources to fund our existing operations for the foreseeable future through our cash flows and borrowings under our credit facility. However, we may need additional capital to operate our business if: o market conditions change o our business plans or assumptions change o we make significant acquisitions o we need to make significant increases in capital expenditures or working capital We cannot assure you that we would be able to raise additional capital on favorable terms, if at all. If we could not obtain sufficient funds to meet our capital requirements, we would have to curtail our business plans. We may also raise funds to meet our capital requirements by issuing additional equity, which could be dilutive to our stockholders, though there can be no assurance that we would be able to do this. RESTRICTIVE COVENANTS IN OUR CREDIT FACILITY MAY RESTRICT OUR ABILITY TO IMPLEMENT OUR GROWTH STRATEGY, RESPOND TO CHANGES IN INDUSTRY CONDITIONS, SECURE ADDITIONAL FINANCING AND MAKE ACQUISITIONS. Our credit facility contains restrictive covenants that: o require us to attain specified pre-tax income o limit our ability to incur additional debt o require us to achieve specific financial ratios o restrict our ability to make capital expenditures or acquisitions If our business needs require us to take on additional debt, secure financing or make significant capital expenditures or acquisitions, and we are unable to comply with these restrictions, we would be forced to negotiate with our lenders to waive these covenants or amend the terms of our credit facility. At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants. Furthermore, as of 26
November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year-end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company's quarter end. The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations. The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year-end. Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company's outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively. Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations. While the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0. This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below. Achieving pre-tax income is significantly dependant upon the timing of customer acceptance of new technologies, customer demand and the ability of our vendors to supply sufficient quantities to fulfill anticipated customer demand, among other factors. THERE ARE CLAIMS OF POSSIBLE HEALTH RISKS FROM WIRELESS HANDSETS. Claims have been made alleging a link between the non-thermal electromagnetic field emitted by wireless handsets and the development of cancer, including brain cancer. The television program 20/20 on ABC reported that several of the handsets available on the market, when used in certain positions, emit radiation to the user's brain in amounts higher than permitted by the Food and Drug Administration. The scientific community is divided on whether there is any risk associated with the use of wireless handsets and, if so, the magnitude of the risk. Unfavorable publicity, whether or not warranted, medical studies or findings or litigation could have a material adverse effect on our growth and financial results. In the past, several plaintiffs' groups have brought class actions against wireless handset manufacturers and distributors, including us, alleging that wireless handsets have caused cancer. To date, none of these actions has been successful. However, actions based on these or other claims may succeed in the future and have a material adverse effect on us. 27
SEVERAL DOMESTIC AND FOREIGN GOVERNMENTS ARE CONSIDERING, OR HAVE RECENTLY ADOPTED, LEGISLATION THAT RESTRICTS THE USE OF WIRELESS HANDSETS WHILE DRIVING. Several foreign governments have adopted, and a number of U.S. state and local governments are considering or have recently enacted, legislation that would restrict or prohibit the use of a wireless handset while driving a vehicle or, alternatively, require the use of a hands-free telephone. For example, Ohio and New York have adopted statutes that restricts the use of wireless handsets or requires the use of a hands-free kit while driving. Widespread legislation that restricts or prohibits the use of wireless handsets while operating a vehicle could have a material adverse effect on our future growth. OUR STOCK PRICE COULD FLUCTUATE SIGNIFICANTLY. The market price of our common stock could fluctuate significantly in response to various factors and events, including: o operating results being below market expectations o announcements of technological innovations or new products by us or our competitors o loss of a major customer or supplier o changes in, or our failure to meet, financial estimates by securities analysts o industry developments o economic and other external factors o period-to-period fluctuations in our financial results o financial crises in foreign countries o general downgrading of our industry sector by securities analysts In addition, the securities markets have experienced significant price and volume fluctuations over the past several years that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies. These market fluctuations may also have a material adverse effect on the market price of our common stock. OUR SECURITIES WILL CONTINUE TO BE LISTED ON THE NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET PURSUANT TO EXCEPTIONS. Following the Company's hearing with the NASDAQ related to its late filing of its annual and quarterly report with the SEC, the Company was notified that it must become timely in its filings and continue in the future to be timely to insure its continued listing on The Nasdaq National Market. JOHN J. SHALAM, OUR PRESIDENT AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER, OWNS A SIGNIFICANT PORTION OF OUR COMMON STOCK AND CAN EXERCISE CONTROL OVER OUR AFFAIRS. Mr. Shalam beneficially owns approximately 54% of the combined voting power of both classes of common stock. This will allow him to elect our Board of Directors and, in general, to determine the outcome of any other matter submitted to the stockholders for approval. Mr. Shalam's voting power may have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in control of Audiovox. 28
We have two classes of common stock: Class A common stock is traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol VOXX, and Class B common stock, which is not publicly traded and substantially all of which is beneficially owned by Mr. Shalam. Each share of Class A common stock is entitled to one vote per share and each share of Class B common stock is entitled to ten votes per share. Both classes vote together as a single class, except in certain circumstances, for the election and removal of directors and as otherwise may be required by Delaware law. Since our charter permits shareholder action by written consent, Mr. Shalam may be able to take significant corporate actions without prior notice and a shareholder meeting. ITEM 2 - PROPERTIES As of November 30, 2002, the Company leased a total of twenty-six operating facilities located in eleven states. The leases have been classified as operating leases, with the exception of one, which is recorded as a capital lease. Wireless utilizes ten of these facilities located in California, New York, Virginia, Pennsylvania and Canada. The Electronics Group utilizes 16 of these facilities located in California, Florida, Georgia, Massachusetts, New York, Ohio, Tennessee, Texas and Michigan. These facilities serve as offices, warehouses, distribution centers or retail locations for both Wireless and Electronics. Additionally, the Company utilizes public warehouse facilities located in Norfolk, Virginia and Sparks, Nevada for its Electronics Group and in Miami, Florida, Toronto, Canada, Farmingdale, New York, Rancho Dominguez, California and Tilburg, Netherlands for its Wireless Group. The Company also leases facilities in Venezuela for its Electronics Group. ITEM 3 - LEGAL PROCEEDINGS The Company is currently, and has in the past been, a party to routine litigation incidental to its business. From time to time, the Company receives notification of alleged violations of registered patent holders' rights. The Company has either been indemnified by its manufacturers in these matters, obtained the benefit of a patent license or has decided to vigorously defend such claims. On November 6, 2002, Audiovox Electronics Corporation ("AEC") was served with a summons and complaint in an action for patent infringement that was instituted by Nissho Iwai American Corporation against AEC in the United State District Court for the Southern District of New York. The complaint seeks equitable relief and damages for alleged infringement of a patent. AEC has meritorious defenses to this claim and has decided to vigorously defend this action. However, the Company cannot be certain of the outcome of this matter. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company and Audiovox Communications Corp. ("ACC"), along with other manufacturers of wireless phones and cellular service providers, were named as defendants in two class action lawsuits alleging non-compliance with FCC ordered emergency 911 call processing capabilities. There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date. These lawsuits have been consolidated and transferred to the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois. The Company and ACC intend to vigorously defend this matter. However, no assurances regarding the outcome of this matter can be given at this point in the litigation. In July 2002, Audiovox Communications Corp. instituted suit against Northcoast Communications, LLC in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of Suffolk seeking recovery of the sum of 29
$1,818 as the balance due it for cellular telephones sold and delivered. In its answer Northcoast interposed counterclaims including fraud, negligent misrepresentation and breach of contract seeking damages in excess of $10,000. The parties have recently served discovery demands and no depositions have been taken to date. Based on discussions with management and review of Audiovox's documents, Northcoast's counterclaims appear to be without merit and interposed to avoid payment of the underlying indebtedness. The Company is the subject of an administrative agency investigation involving alleged reimbursement of a fixed nominal amount of federal campaign contributions during the years 1995 through 1996. The Company has fully cooperated with the investigation and believes that it has committed no wrongdoing. The Company had previously reported that during 2001, ACC, along with other suppliers, manufacturers and distributors as well as wireless carriers of hand-held wireless telephones had been named as a defendant in five state court class action lawsuits (Pinney, Farina, Gilliam, Gimpelson and Naquin) alleging damages relating to risk of exposure to radio frequency radiation from the wireless telephones. These lawsuits were removed to their respective federal district courts and thereafter consolidated and transferred to a federal Multi-District Litigation Panel before the United States District Court for the District of Maryland. On March 5, 2003, Judge Catherine C. Blake of the United States District Court for the District of Maryland granted the defendants' consolidated motion to dismiss these complaints. Plaintiffs have appealed to the United States Circuit Court of Appeals, Fourth Circuit. It is anticipated that the appeal will be heard in late 2003 or early 2004. The Company does not expect the outcome of any pending litigation, separately and in the aggregate, to have a material adverse effect on its business, consolidated financial position or results of operations. ITEM 4 - SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS No matters were submitted to a vote of security holders during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002. 30
PART II ------- ITEM 5 - MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS Summary of Stock Prices and Dividend Data The Class A Common Stock of Audiovox are traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol VOXX. No dividends have been paid on the Company's common stock. The Company is restricted by agreements with its financial institutions from the payment of common stock dividends while certain loans are outstanding (see Liquidity and Capital Resources of Management's Discussion and Analysis). There are approximately 566 holders of record of our Class A Common Stock and four holders of Class B Convertible Common Stock. Class A Common Stock Average Daily Trading Fiscal Period High Low Volume - ------------- ---- --- ------ 2001 First Quarter 14.13 7.38 373,083 Second Quarter 12.13 7.28 162,019 Third Quarter 12.10 8.37 82,509 Fourth Quarter 9.39 5.90 105,022 2002 First Quarter 8.25 6.00 117,420 Second Quarter 8.93 6.50 82,356 Third Quarter 9.05 5.95 91,708 Fourth Quarter 11.53 6.30 71,940 ITEM 6 - SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA The following selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, the notes to the consolidated financial statements and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," which are included elsewhere in this report. The consolidated statements of operations data for each of the five fiscal years in the period ended November 30, 2002, and the consolidated balance sheet data as of the end of each such fiscal year, are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements (in thousands except per share data). 31
See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--Recent Event" and Note 2, "Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements", and Note 26, "Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated" of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for more detailed information regarding the restatement of our consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and restated unaudited quarterly data for fiscal quarters during the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and the fiscal 2002 quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002, respectively. The Company did not restate fiscal years ended November 30, 1998 and 1999 as any restatement amounts applicable to those years were not material and were recorded in 2000. Years Ended November 30, -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Consolidated Statement of Operations Data Net sales (1)(2) $606,108 $1,149,537 $1,670,291 $1,276,591 $1,100,382 Net income (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 2,972 27,246 25,303 (7,198) (14,280) Extraordinary item - - 2,189 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill - - - - 240 Net income (loss) 2,972 27,246 27,492 (7,198) (14,040) Net income (loss) per common share before extraordinary item and cumulative effect: Basic 0.16 1.43 1.19 (0.33) (0.65) Diluted 0.16 1.39 1.12 (0.33) (0.65) Net income (loss) per common share: Basic 0.16 1.43 1.29 (0.33) (0.64) Diluted 0.16 1.39 1.22 (0.33) (0.64) Consolidated Balance Sheet Data Total assets $287,816 $ 486,220 $ 517,586 $ 544,497 $ 551,235 Working capital 160,609 272,081 305,369 284,166 292,687 Long-term obligations, less current installments 33,724 122,798 23,468 10,040 18,250 Stockholders' equity 177,720 216,744 330,766 323,220 309,513 (1) Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, "Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer". Upon adoption of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives offered to its customers from selling expenses to net sales. For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented. (2) In fiscal 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF Issue No. 00-10, "Accounting for Shipping and Handling Fees and Costs", which requires the Company to report all amounts billed to a customer related to shipping and handling as revenue. The Company has reclassified such billed amounts, which were previously netted in cost of sales, to net sales. Gross profit has remained unchanged by this adoption. For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications 32
have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented. ITEM 7 - MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS Forward-looking Statements This Report on Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Words such as "may," "believe," "estimate," "expect," "plan," "intend," "project," "anticipate," "continues," "could," "potential," "predict" and similar expressions may identify forward-looking statements. The Company has based these forward-looking statements on its current expectations and projections about future events, activities or developments. The Company's actual results could differ materially from those discussed in or implied by these forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements include statements relating to, among other things: o growth trends in the wireless, automotive, mobile and consumer electronic businesses o technological and market developments in the wireless, automotive, mobile and consumer electronics businesses o liquidity o availability of key employees o expansion into international markets o the availability of new consumer electronic products These forward-looking statements are subject to numerous risks, uncertainties and assumptions about the Company including, among other things: o the ability to keep pace with technological advances o impact of future selling prices on Company profitability and inventory carrying value o significant competition in the wireless, automotive and consumer electronics businesses o quality and consumer acceptance of newly introduced products o the relationships with key suppliers o the relationships with key customers o possible increases in warranty expense o the loss of key employees o foreign currency risks o political instability o changes in U.S. federal, state and local and foreign laws o changes in regulations and tariffs o seasonality and cyclicality o inventory obsolescence and availability o consolidations in the wireless and retail industries, causing a decrease in the number of carriers and retail stores that carry our products o changes in global or local economic conditions Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements 33
The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002. In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002. These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles. The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows: First Second Third Fiscal Fiscal Quarter Quarter Quarter 2000 2001 2002 2002 2002 ------ ------ ------ ------ ----- (Unaudited) (Unaudited) (Unaudited) Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ 263 $1,011 $(1,308) $ (782) $ 751 Increase (decrease) net income (increase) decrease net (loss) 263 1,011 (1,308) (782) 751 Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted $0.01 $ 0.05 $ (0.06) $(0.03) $ 0.04 The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments: EFFECTS OF RESTATEMENT ADJUSTMENTS ON NET INCOME OR NET LOSS (IN THOUSANDS) Increase (Decrease) (Increase) Decrease Increase (Decrease) in Net Income for the in Net Loss for the in Net Income for the Fiscal Year Ended Fiscal Year Ended Nine Months Ended November 30, 2000 November 30, 2001 August 31, 2002 ----------------- ----------------- ---------------- Unaudited Restatement adjustments: Revenue recognition $ (779) $ 779 - Timing of revenue (15) $ (103) Litigation (373) 427 Foreign currency translation - - (1,491) Inventory pricing - - 420 Sales incentives 1,884 910 847 Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares - - (1,556) Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2) - - - ---------- -------- -------- Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss) 1,105 1,301 (1,456) (Provision for) recovery of income taxes (842) (310) 204 Minority interest (1) - 20 (87) ---------- -------- -------- Total effect on net income (loss) $ 263 $ 1,011 $ (1,339) ========== ======== ======== (1) This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 34
(2) This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein. See Note 2, "Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements", of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported fiscal years 2000 and 2001 and Note 26, "Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data- As Restated", of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications. The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment for the corrections of accounting errors. Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited. Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming). The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101 (SAB No. 101), "Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements", which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company. These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000. During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001. Timing of revenue. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers. SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is, in this situation, when the product was delivered to the customer's site). Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer's site. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively. Litigation. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its provisions for certain litigation matters, thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period. Also, the Company understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it. 35
During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim. The Company's insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company. The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful. The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery. Foreign currency translation. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy. In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change. The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income. As a result, the Company understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002. Also the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. Inventory pricing. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary. The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002 and, accordingly, was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. Sales incentives. During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances) that were not offered to its customers. As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively. Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002,the Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period. As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively. Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares. During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital. This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended 36
May 31, 2002. As a result, the Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556. Income taxes. Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented. The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002. As a result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. Operating expense reclassification. The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included as a component of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales. The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively. The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein. This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. Business Overview The Company markets its products under the Audiovox brand name as well as private labels through a large and diverse distribution network both domestically and internationally. The Company operates through two marketing groups: Wireless and Electronics. Wireless consists of Audiovox Communications Corp. (ACC), a 75%-owned subsidiary of Audiovox, and Quintex, which is a wholly- owned subsidiary of ACC. ACC markets wireless handsets and accessories primarily on a wholesale basis to wireless carriers in the United States and carriers overseas. Quintex is a small operation for the direct sale of handsets, accessories and wireless telephone service. Quintex also receives residual fees and activation commissions from the carriers. Residuals are paid by the carriers based upon a percentage of usage of customers activated by Quintex for a period of time (1-5 years). Quintex also sells a small volume of electronics products not related to wireless which are categorized as "other". The Electronics Group consists of three wholly-owned subsidiaries: Audiovox Electronics Corporation (AEC), American Radio Corp. and Code Systems, Inc. (Code) and three majority-owned subsidiaries, Audiovox Communications (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd., Audiovox Holdings (M) Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela, C.A. The Electronics Group markets, both domestically and internationally, automotive sound and security systems, electronic car accessories, home and portable sound products, FRS radios, in-vehicle video systems, flat-screen televisions, DVD players and navigation systems. Sales are made through an extensive distribution network of mass merchandisers and others. In addition, the Company sells some of its products directly to automobile manufacturers on an OEM basis. American Radio Corp. is also involved on a limited basis in the wireless marketplace. Wireless related sales are categorized as "other". 37
The Company allocates interest and certain shared expenses, including treasury, legal, human resources and information systems, to the marketing groups based upon both actual and estimated usage. General expenses and other income items that are not readily allocable are not included in the results of the two marketing groups. From fiscal 1998 through 2002, several major events and trends have affected the Company's results and financial conditions. Wireless increased its handset sales from 3.3 million units in fiscal 1998 to an all-time high of 8.9 million units in fiscal 2000 as a result of the introduction of digital technology, reduced cost of service plans and expanded feature options which attracted more subscribers to the carriers systems. During 2001 through 2002, as a result of the change in technology from analog to digital, the consolidation of our carrier customer base and increased price competition from our competitors, the Company's overall wireless growth was impacted. Further during this period, the addition of several new competitors had an effect on the Company's sales. These factors resulted in a reduction of our net sales to 5.0 million units in 2002. This overall trend in our wireless business from 1998 was impacted by: o the introduction of digital technology, which has allowed carriers to significantly increase subscriber capacity o reduced cost of service and expanded feature options o consolidation of carrier customers o price competition o increased competition In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company recorded inventory write-downs to market of $8,152, $20,650 and $13,823, respectively. These write-downs were primarily due to increased pricing pressures, competition and changing technologies. Wireless' gross profit margins were negatively impacted by 0.6, 2.1 and 1.8 percentage points, respectively, as a result of these write-downs. This trend of competition, price erosion, and changing technologies will continue to affect the overall wireless business segment. In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, Wireless recorded $8,265, $12,555 and $3,216, respectively, into income due to reversals of previously established sales incentive accruals. Wireless' gross profit margins were positively impacted by 0.6, 1.3 and 0.4 percentage points, respectively, as a result of these reversals. See further discussion in critical accounting policies. Sales by the Electronics Group were $175.1 million in 1998 and $372.7 million in 2002. During this period, the Company's sales were impacted by the following items: o the growth of our consumer electronic products business from $11.7 million in fiscal 1998 to $86.5 million in fiscal 2002 was a result of the introduction of new consumer goods o the introduction of mobile video entertainment systems and other new technologies o growth of OEM business 38
Both of the Company's segments, Electronics and Wireless, are influenced by the introduction of new products and changes in technology (see Cautionary Factors That May Affect Future Results: Our success depends on our ability to keep pace with technological advances in the wireless industry). During fiscal 2002, the Company introduced several new products in our Electronics segment, which included an extended line of portable DVD products for the consumer market, new flat panel TV's and satellite radios. In our Wireless group, the technology has evolved to new 1X technology, color view screens for the phones, PDA's with built-in wireless capabilities and certain 1X phones have the availability to utilize the new GPS locator systems. As a result of the continuous introduction of new products, the Company must sell existing older models prior to new product introduction or the value of the inventory may be impacted (See Critical Accounting Policies - Inventory, MD&A Discussions). Gross margins in the Company's electronics business have decreased to 16.1% for fiscal 2002 from 20.5% in 1998 due, in part, to a change in the product mix, partially offset by higher margins in mobile video products, other new technologies and products and the growth of the international business. In fiscal 2000, 2001 and 2002, Electronics recorded $0, $132 and $588, respectively, into income upon the expiration of unclaimed sales incentive accruals. Electronics' gross profit margins were positively impacted by 0.0, 0.1 and 0.2 percentage points, respectively, as a result of this. The Company's total operating expenses have increased at a slower rate than sales since 1998. Total operating expenses were $70.5 million in 1998 and $88.6 million in 2002. The Company has invested in management information systems and its operating facilities to increase its efficiency. During the period 1998 to 2002, the Company's financial position was improved by the 2.3 million share follow-on offering in which the Company received $96.6 million net proceeds and the sale of 25% of its previously 100%-owned subsidiary, ACC, to Toshiba for $27.2 million. All financial information, except share and per share data, is presented in thousands. Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates General The consolidated financial statements of the Company are prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. As such, the Company is required to make certain estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believes are reasonable based upon the information available. These estimates and assumptions, which can be subjective and complex, affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the dates of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. As a result, actual results could differ from such estimates and assumptions. The significant accounting policies which the Company believes are the most critical to aid in fully understanding and evaluating the reported consolidated financial results include the following: Revenue Recognition 39
The Company recognizes revenue from product sales at the time of passage of title and risk of loss to the customer either at FOB Shipping Point or FOB Destination, based upon terms established with the customer. Any customer acceptance provisions are satisfied prior to revenue recognition. There are no further obligations on the part of the Company subsequent to revenue recognition except for returns of product from the Company's customers. The Company does accept returns of products, if properly requested, authorized, and approved by the Company. The Company records an estimate of returns of products returned by its customers. Management continuously monitors and tracks such product returns and records the provision for the estimated amount of such future returns, based on historical experience and any notification the Company receives of pending returns. The Electronic segment's selling price to its customers is a fixed amount that is not subject to refund or adjustment or contingent upon additional rebates. The Wireless segment has sales agreements with certain customers that provide for a rebate of the selling price if the particular product is subsequently sold at a lower price. The Wireless segment records an estimate of the rebate at the time of sale. Accounts Receivable The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and adjusts credit limits based upon payment history and the customer's current credit worthiness, as determined by a review of their current credit information. The Company continuously monitors collections and payments from its customers and maintains a provision for estimated credit losses based upon historical experience and any specific customer collection issues that have been identified. The Company's reserve for estimated credit losses at November 30, 2002 was $6,829. While such credit losses have historically been within management's expectations and the provisions established, the Company cannot guarantee that it will continue to experience the same credit loss rates that have been experienced in the past. Since the Company's accounts receivable is concentrated in a relatively few number of customers, a significant change in the liquidity or financial position of any one of these customers could have a material adverse impact on the collectability of the Company's accounts receivables and future operating results. Sales Incentives Both of the Company's segments, Wireless and Electronics, offer sales incentives to its customers in the form of (1) co-operative advertising allowances; (2) market development funds and (3) volume incentive rebates. The Electronics segment also offers other trade allowances to its customers. The terms of the sales incentives vary by customer and are offered from time to time. Except for other trade allowances, all sales incentives require the customer to purchase the Company's products during a specified period of time. All sales incentives require the customer to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period. Although all sales incentives require customers to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period (referred to as the "claim period"), the Wireless segment historically has settled sales incentives claimed after the claim period has expired if a customer demands payment. The sales incentive liabilities are settled either by the customer claiming a deduction against an outstanding account receivable owed to the Company by the customer or by the customer requesting a check from the Company. The Company is unable to demonstrate that an identifiable benefit of the sales incentives has been received as such, all costs associated with sales incentives are classified as a reduction of net sales. The following is a summary of the various sales incentive programs offered by the Company and the related accounting policies: 40
Co-operative advertising allowances are offered to customers as reimbursement towards their costs for print or media advertising in which our product is featured on its own or in conjunction with other companies' products (e.g., a weekly advertising circular by a mass merchant). The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period. Market development funds are offered to customers in connection with new product launches or entering into new markets. Those new markets can be either new geographic areas or new customers. The amount offered for new product launches is based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period. The Company accrues the cost of co-operative advertising allowances and market development funds at the later of when the customer purchases our products or when the sales incentive is offered to the customer. Volume incentive rebates offered to customers require that minimum quantities of product be purchased during a specified period of time. The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer. Certain of the volume incentive rebates offered to customers include a sliding scale of the amount of the sales incentive with different required minimum quantities to be purchased. The customer's achievement of the sales threshold and consequently the measurement of the total rebate for the Wireless segment cannot be reasonably estimated. Accordingly, the Wireless segment recognizes a liability for the maximum potential amount of the rebate with the exception of certain volume incentive rebates that include very aggressive tiered levels of volume purchases, as the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward earning the rebate or refund on a program by program basis are recognized. The Electronics segment makes an estimate of the ultimate amount of the rebate their customers will earn based upon past history with the customer and other facts and circumstances. The Electronics segment has the ability to estimate these volume incentive rebates, as there does not exist a relatively long period of time for a particular rebate to be claimed, the Electronics segment does have historical experience with these sales incentive programs and the Electronics segment does have a large volume of relatively homogenous transactions. Any changes in the estimated amount of volume incentive rebates are recognized immediately using a cumulative catch-up adjustment. With respect to the accounting for co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds and volume incentive rebates, there was no impact upon the adoption of EITF 01-9, "Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer (Including a Reseller of Vendor's Products)", as the Company's accounting policy prior to March 1, 2002 was consistent with its accounting policy after the adoption of EITF 01-9. Other trade allowances are additional sales incentives that the Company provides to the Electronics segment customers subsequent to the related revenue being recognized. In accordance with EITF 01-9, the Company records the provision for these additional sales incentives at the later of when the sales incentive is offered or when the related revenue is recognized. Such additional sales incentives are based upon a fixed percentage of the selling price to the customer, a fixed amount per unit, or a lump-sum amount. For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities amounted to $9,348, $14,369 and $4,716, respectively. These reversals include unearned sales incentives and unclaimed sales incentives. Unearned sales incentives are volume incentive rebates where the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the 41
specified time. Volume incentive rebates for both segments are reversed into income in the period when the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified time. Unearned sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $4,167, $9,051 and $1,354, respectively. Unclaimed sales incentives are sales incentives earned by the customer but the customer has not claimed payment of the earned sales incentive from the Company. Unclaimed sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $5,181, $5,318 and $3,362, respectively. The accrual for earned but unclaimed sales incentives is reversed by Wireless only when management is able to conclude, based upon an individual judgment of each sales incentive, that it is remote that the customer will claim the sales incentive. The methodology applied for determining the amount and timing of reversals for the Wireless segment is disciplined, consistent and rational. The methodology is not systematic (formula based), as the Company makes an estimate as to when it is remote that the sales incentive will not be claimed. Reversals by the Wireless segment of unclaimed sales incentives have historically occurred in varying periods up to 12 months after the recognition of the accrual. In deciding on whether to reverse the sales incentive liability into income, the Company makes an assessment as to the likelihood of the customer ever claiming the funds after the claim period has expired and considers the specific facts and circumstances pertaining to the individual sales incentive. The factors considered by management in making the decision to reverse accruals for unclaimed sales incentives include (i) past practices of the customer requesting payments after the expiration of the claim period; (ii) recent negotiations with the customer for new sales incentives; (iii) subsequent communications with the customer with regard to the status of the claim; and (iv) recent activity in the customer's account. The Electronics segment reverses earned but unclaimed sales incentives upon the expiration of the claim period. The Company believes that the reversal of earned but unclaimed sales incentives for Electronics upon the expiration of the claim period is a disciplined, rational, consistent and systematic method of reversing unclaimed sales incentives. For the Electronics segment, the majority of sales incentive programs are calendar-year programs. Accordingly, the program ends on the month following the fiscal year-end and the claim period expires one year from the end of the program. The accrual for sales incentives at November 30, 2001 and 2002 was $8,474 and $12,151, respectively. The Company's sales incentive liability may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for these arrangements. Therefore, although the Company makes its best estimate of its sales incentive liability, many factors, including significant unanticipated changes in the purchasing volume of its customers and the lack of claims made by customers of offered and accepted sales incentives, could have significant impact on the Company's liability for sales incentives and the Company's reported operating results. Inventories The Company values its inventory at the lower of the actual cost to purchase and/or the current estimated market value of the inventory less expected costs to sell the inventory. The Company regularly reviews inventory quantities on-hand and records a provision for excess and obsolete inventory based primarily on open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations. As demonstrated in recent years, demand for the Company's products can fluctuate significantly. A significant sudden 42
increase in the demand for the Company's products could result in a short-term increase in the cost of inventory purchases while a significant decrease in demand could result in an increase in the amount of excess inventory quantities on-hand. In addition, the Company's industry is characterized by rapid technological change and frequent new product introductions that could result in an increase in the amount of obsolete inventory quantities on-hand. In such situations, the Company generally does not obtain price protection from its vendors, however, on occasion, the Company has received price protection which reduces the cost of inventory. Since price protection reduces the cost of inventory, as the Company sells the inventory for which it has received price protection, the amount is reflected as a reduction to cost of sales. There can be no assurances that the Company will be successful in negotiating such price protection from its vendors in the future. The Company has, on occasion, performed upgrades on certain inventory on behalf of its vendors. The reimbursements the Company receives to perform these upgrades are reflected as a reduction to the cost of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory is sold. Additionally, the Company's estimates of excess and obsolete inventory may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for excess and obsolete inventory. In the future, if the Company's inventory is determined to be overvalued, it would be required to recognize such costs in its cost of goods sold at the time of such determination. Likewise, if the Company does not properly estimate the lower of cost or market of its inventory and it is therefore determined to be undervalued, it may have over-reported its cost of goods sold in previous periods and would be required to recognize such additional operating income at the time of sale. Therefore, although the Company makes every effort to ensure the accuracy of its forecasts of future product demand, any significant unanticipated changes in demand or technological developments could have a significant impact on the value of the Company's inventory and its reported operating results. During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Company recorded inventory write-downs to market of $13,823 as a result of the recent reduction of selling prices primarily related to digital hand-held phones and other wireless products in anticipation and the introduction of new digital technologies as well as the overall decrease in demand for wireless products. At November 30, 2002, Wireless had on hand 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory, which approximated $94,264. It is reasonably possible that additional write-downs to market may be required in the future, given the continued emergence of new technologies. (See Cautionary Factors That May Affect Future Results: Our success depends on our ability to keep pace with technological advances in the wireless industry). Warranties The Company offers warranties of various lengths depending upon the specific product. The Company's standard warranties require the Company to repair or replace defective product returned to the Company by both end users and its customers during such warranty period at no cost to the end users or customers. The Company records an estimate for warranty related costs based upon its actual historical return rates and repair costs at the time of sale, which are included in cost of sales. The estimated liability for future warranty expense amounted to $9,143 at November 30, 2002, which has been included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities. While the Company's warranty costs have historically been within its expectations and the provisions established, the Company cannot guarantee that it will continue to experience the same warranty return rates or repair costs that have been experienced in the past. A significant increase in product return rates, or a significant increase in the costs to repair the Company's products, could have a material adverse impact on its operating results for the period or periods in which such returns or additional costs materialize. 43
Income Taxes The Company has accounted for, and currently accounts for, income taxes in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes". This Statement establishes financial accounting and reporting standards for the effects of income taxes that result from an enterprise's activities during the current and preceding years. It requires an asset and liability approach for financial accounting and reporting of income taxes. The realization of tax benefits of deductible temporary differences and operating loss or tax credit carryforwards will depend on whether the Company will have sufficient taxable income of an appropriate character within the carryback and carryforward period permitted by the tax law to allow for utilization of the deductible amounts and carryforwards. Without sufficient taxable income to offset the deductible amounts and carryforwards, the related tax benefits will expire unused. The Company has evaluated both positive and negative evidence in making a determination as to whether it is more likely than not that all or some portion of the deferred tax asset will not be realized. Effective May 29, 2002, the Company's ownership in the Wireless Group was decreased to 75% (see Note 3). As such, the Company no longer files a consolidated U.S. Federal tax return. As a result, the realizability of the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets are assessed on a stand-alone basis. The Company's Wireless Group has incurred cumulative losses in recent years, and therefore based upon these cumulative losses and other material factors (including the Wireless Group's inability to reasonably and accurately estimate future operating and taxable income based upon the volatility of their historical operations), the Company has determined that it is more likely than not that some of the benefits of the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets and carryforwards will expire unused. Accordingly, the Company has recorded an additional valuation allowance of $13,090 during fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets. Furthermore, the Company provides tax reserves for Federal, state and international exposures relating to potential tax examination issues, planning initiatives and compliance responsibilities. The development of these reserves requires judgments about tax issues, potential outcomes and timing and is a subjective critical estimate. 44
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS The following table sets forth for the periods indicated certain statements of operations data for the Company expressed as a percentage of net sales: Percentage of Net Sales Years Ended November 30, -------------------------------------------- 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Net sales (a): Wireless Wireless products 81.4% 74.3% 63.7% Activation commissions 1.7 2.1 2.2 Residual fees 0.1 0.2 0.2 Other 0.2 0.1 0.1 ------------ ------------ -------- Total Wireless 83.4 76.7 66.1 ----------- ----------- ------- Electronics Mobile electronics 8.1 12.4 20.8 Sound 4.6 4.5 5.1 Consumer electronics 3.6 6.3 7.9 Other 0.2 0.1 0.1 ------------ ------------ -------- Total Electronics 16.6 23.6 33.9 ----------- ----------- ------- Total net sales 100.0 100.0 100.0 Cost of sales (92.9) (94.4) (93.2) ---------- ---------- ------- Gross profit 7.1 5.6 6.8 Selling (1.7) (2.4) (2.7) General and administrative (2.8) (3.6) (5.0) Warehousing and technical support (0.2) (0.3) (0.4) ----------- ----------- -------- Total operating expenses (4.7) (6.3) (8.1) ----------- ----------- -------- Operating income (loss) 2.4 (0.7) (1.3) Interest and bank charges (0.4) (0.5) (0.4) Equity in income in equity investments 0.2 0.3 0.2 Gain on sale of investments 0.1 - - Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities 0.1 - - Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares - - 1.3 Other, net 0.1 - (0.4) ----------- ------------- ------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, extraordinary item and cumulative effect 2.5 (0.9) (0.6) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes 0.9 (0.3) 1.2 Minority interest (0.1) 0.1 0.4 Extraordinary item 0.1 - - Cumulative effect - - - ------------- ------------- -------- Net income (loss) 1.6 % (0.6)% (1.3)% ========== ========= ========= (a) Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, "Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer". Upon adoption 45
of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives offered to its customers from selling expenses to net sales. Previously reported operating income (loss) has remained unchanged by this adoption. For purposes of comparability, these reclassifications have been reflected retroactively for all periods presented. The net sales and percentage of net sales by product line and marketing group for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 are reflected in the following table. Certain reclassifications and recaptionings have been made to the data for periods prior to fiscal 2002 in order to conform to fiscal 2002 presentation. Fiscal Years Ended November 30, --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ---------------------------- --------------------------- Net sales: Wireless Products $1,359,366 81.4% $ 948,921 74.3% $ 700,658 63.7% Activation commissions 28,983 1.7 26,879 2.1 24,393 2.2 Residual fees 1,852 0.1 2,396 0.2 2,187 0.2 Other 3,619 0.2 692 0.1 420 0.1 ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- Total Wireless 1,393,820 83.4 978,888 76.7 727,658 66.1 ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- Electronics Mobile electronics 134,563 8.1 157,706 12.4 229,327 20.8 Sound 77,412 4.6 57,456 4.5 56,281 5.1 Consumer electronics 60,547 3.6 80,380 6.3 86,472 7.9 Other 3,949 0.2 2,160 0.1 644 0.1 ---------- ----- --------- ----- ---------- ----- Total Electronics 276,471 16.6 297,702 23.3 372,724 33.9 ---------- ----- --------- ----- ---------- ----- Total $1,670,291 100.0% $1,276,591 100.0% $1,100,382 100.0% ========== ===== ========== ===== ========== ===== FISCAL 2001 (AS RESTATED) COMPARED TO FISCAL 2002 CONSOLIDATED RESULTS Net sales for fiscal 2002 were $1,100,382, a 13.8% decrease from net sales of $1,276,591 in fiscal 2001. Wireless Group sales were $727,658 in fiscal year 2002, a 25.7% decrease from sales of $978,888 in fiscal 2001. Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased 29.3% to approximately 4,950,000 units in fiscal 2002 from approximately 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001. However, the average selling price of the Company's handsets increased to $136 per unit in fiscal 2002 from $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 as a result of new product introductions. Wireless sales were impacted by late introductions of new products by its vendor, delays in acceptances testing by our customers and slower growth in the wireless industry. Electronics Group sales were $372,724 in fiscal 2002, a 25.2% increase from sales of $297,702 in fiscal 2001. This increase was largely due to increased sales in the mobile video and consumer electronics product lines as newer digital video products were offered to our customers. Offsetting some of this increase were sound sales, which continue to decline given the change in the marketplace as fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being 46
sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line. Sales by the Company's international subsidiaries decreased 21.5% in fiscal 2002 to approximately $21,971 due to a 39.2% decrease in Venezuela due to political and economic instability and a 7.4% decrease in Malaysia as a result of lower OEM sales. Sales were also impacted by increased sales incentives of $23,035, primarily in the Wireless Group. Gross profit margin for fiscal 2002 was 6.8%, compared to 5.6% in fiscal 2001. However, this increase in profit margin resulted primarily from lower inventory write-downs to market of $7,612 in 2002 compared to 2001. During fiscal 2002, there was no significant impact to our gross profit margins on the subsequent sale of previously written-down inventory. There was also a change in the mix of sales from Wireless product sales to Electronics product sales, which carry a higher gross margin. Wireless margins were impacted by late product introductions by its suppliers. This trend of late product introductions continues to have a major effect on the gross margins of the Wireless Group. Margins declined to 16.1% from 16.5% in the Electronics Group. Consolidated gross margins were also adversely impacted by increased sales incentives, principally in the Wireless Group. Further trends in the operations will be discussed in detail in each individual marketing group MD&A discussion. Operating expenses increased $8,049 to $88,675 in fiscal 2002, compared to $80,626 in fiscal 2001. As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 8.1% in fiscal 2002 from 6.3% in fiscal 2001. Major components of this increase were compensation expenses of $3,200 related to the sale of ACC shares to Toshiba and the impact of Code acquisition (Note 6 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements) of $1,852. Additionally, bad debt expenses increased $2,948 principally in the Wireless Group as a result of economic conditions in South America and increased insurance expense, particularly with general liability insurance, of $1,167. This increase in operating expenses was partially offset by reductions in employee benefits expense of $1,332 due to reduced bonuses and lower health care costs. Operating loss for fiscal 2002 was $14,076, compared to operating loss of $9,236 in 2001. Net loss for fiscal 2002 was $14,040 compared to net loss of $7,198 in fiscal 2001. Loss per share for fiscal 2002 was $0.64, basic and diluted compared to $0.33 for fiscal 2001, basic and diluted. 47
WIRELESS RESULTS The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of operations data for Wireless expressed as a percentage of net sales: 2001 2002 ------ ----- As Restated ----------------------------- Net sales: Wireless products $ 948,921 96.9% $ 700,658 96.3% Activation commissions 26,879 2.8 24,393 3.3 Residual fees 2,396 0.2 2,187 0.3 Other 692 0.1 420 0.1 --------- ----- --------- ----- Total net sales 978,888 100.0 727,658 100.0 Gross profit 21,980 2.2 14,291 2.0 Operating expenses Selling 13,108 1.3 11,148 1.5 General and administrative 16,077 1.6 21,522 3.0 Warehousing and technical support 2,761 0.3 2,593 0.4 --------- ----- --------- ----- Total operating expenses 31,946 3.2 35,263 4.9 --------- ----- --------- ----- Operating loss (9,966) (1.0) (20,972) (2.9) Other expense (7,690) (0.8) (3,934) (0.5) --------- ----- --------- ----- Pre-tax loss $ (17,656) (1.8)% $ (24,906) (3.4)% ========= ====== ========= ===== Wireless is composed of ACC and Quintex, both subsidiaries of the Company. Net sales were $727,658 in fiscal 2002, a decrease of $251,230, or 25.7%, from fiscal 2001. Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased by 2,050,000 units in fiscal 2002, or 29.3%, to approximately 4,950,000 units from 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001. This decrease was attributable to decreased sales of digital handsets due to delayed new product introductions, longer testing cycles required by our customers and overall lower demand for wireless products. In addition, there was a $20,845 of a net increase in sales incentives expense compared to 2001 due to increased sales incentive programs and a reduction in the reversals for unclaimed sales incentives. In connection with the introduction of the new 1X phones, one sales incentive program with a large customer resulted in an increase of $18,000 in sales incentives. The reversals for unclaimed sales incentives decreased by $2,374 in fiscal 2002 compared to fiscal 2001 for Wireless due to more of the Company's larger customers claiming earned sales incentives as compared to prior periods. These sales incentive programs are expected to continue and will either increase or decrease based upon competition and customer demands. The average selling price of handsets, however, increased to $136 per unit in fiscal 2002 from $127 per unit in fiscal 2001. This increase was due to higher selling prices of the newly-introduced 1X digital products. Gross profit margins remained essentially unchanged at 2.0% vs. 2.2% in 2001 due to the sales of new, higher margin products and lower inventory write-downs, offset by increased sales incentive programs. The Company expects due to market conditions, competition and customer concentration, it could experience increased sales incentives expense in the future. Inventory write-downs were $20,650 48
in 2001 compared to $13,823 in 2002. The write-downs recorded in 2002 were a result of the reduction of selling prices primarily related to older model, digital hand-held phones and other wireless products in anticipation of newer digital technologies. At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand approximately 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory which, after write-down, had an extended value of $94,264. The new technology that was introduced during the second quarter of 2002 was 1XXT and GPS phones. In addition to inventory write-downs recorded in previous quarters, the Company determined the valuation of the older technology digital models on hand as of November 30, 2002 by reviewing open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon current negotiations. The Company plans to sell these items to its existing customers during the next year. A majority of the units that were previously written-down in fiscal 2001 have been sold. The remaining balance of inventory previously written-down in fiscal 2001 is not material and will be sold in the next fiscal year. None of this inventory was scrapped. The Company expects that, due to market conditions and customer consolidation, it could experience additional write-downs in the future. Gross margins were favorably impacted by reimbursement from a vendor for software upgrades performed on inventory sold of $1,615 and $1,331 for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively. Without this reimbursement, gross margins would have been lower by 0.1% and 0.2% for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively. The Company has received price protection of $4,550 and $32,643 for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively, from a vendor for certain inventory, of which $4,550 and $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales, as related inventory was sold. The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost. Without this price protection, gross profit margins would have been lower by 0.5% and 4.5% for fiscal 2001 and 2002, respectively. The Company has an agreement with its vendor for additional future price protection with respect to specific inventory items, if needed. Operating expenses increased $3,317 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001. As a percentage of net sales operating expenses increased to 4.8% during fiscal 2002 compared to 3.3% in fiscal 2001. Selling expenses decreased $1,960 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in commissions of $2,246 from reduced sales in Mexico, $587 from reduced sales in Europe and the balance from lower over-all commissionable sales. Travel and entertainment decreased $126 due to a reduction in the sales force and less international travel. These decreases were partially offset by increases in advertising and trade show expense of $498 primarily due to increased sales promotions and broadcast media advertising of $274. Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations account for the remaining net change in selling expenses. General and administrative expenses increased $5,445 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in salaries of $2,818 due to $3,200 bonus payments associated with the Toshiba transaction (Note 3), insurance expense of $681 due to increased insurance premiums for general liability coverage, occupancy costs of $128 due to increased rent, real estate taxes and utilities, bad debt expense of $2,853 primarily due to two accounts in Venezuela and Argentina as a result of the political and economic conditions and one account in the United States for slow payment. The Company does not consider this a trend in the overall accounts receivable. Depreciation and amortization increased $236 due to purchase of additional testing equipment as new 1X product is being introduced. These increases were partially offset by decreases in travel and entertainment of $193 due to less salesmen traveling as a result of lower sales and a reduced budget for travel and entertainment, employee benefits of $634 as a result of reduction in profit bonus and reductions in health plan costs due to improved claim experience and licenses of $466 due to a non-recurring licensing fee. Warehousing and technical support expenses decreased $168 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily in direct labor, taxes and benefits of $130 and overseas buying offices of $107 due to lower expenses in the buying offices in South Korea as a result of reduced sales. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in travel of 49
$69 due to increased travel for product compliance testing. Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations in various categories account for the remaining net change in operating expenses. Pre-tax loss for fiscal 2002 was $24,906, compared to $17,656 for fiscal 2001. Management believes that the wireless industry is extremely competitive and that this competition could affect gross margins and the carrying value of inventories in the future as new competitors enter the marketplace. This pressure from increased competition is further enhanced by the consolidation of many of Wireless' customers into a smaller group, dominated by only a few, large customers. Also, timely delivery and carrier acceptance of new product could affect our quarterly performance. These new products require extensive testing and software development which could delay entry into the market and affect our sales in the future. In addition, given the anticipated emergence of new technologies in the wireless industry, the Company will need to sell existing inventory quantities of current technologies to avoid further write-downs to market. ELECTRONICS RESULTS The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of income data for the Electronics Group expressed as a percentage of net sales: 2001 2002 ------ ----- As Restated ----------------------------- Net sales: Mobile electronics $157,706 53.0% $229,327 61.5% Sound 57,456 19.3 56,281 15.1 Consumer electronics 80,380 27.0 86,472 23.2 Other 2,160 0.7 644 0.2 --------- ------ --------- ----- Total net sales 297,702 100.0 372,724 100.0 Gross profit 49,088 16.5 60,037 16.1 Operating expenses Selling 14,449 4.9 15,944 4.3 General and administrative 19,547 6.6 23,300 6.2 Warehousing and technical support 1,134 0.3 1,137 0.3 --------- ------ -------- ------ Total operating expenses 35,130 11.8 40,381 10.8 --------- ------ -------- ------ Operating income 13,958 4.7 19,656 5.3 Other expense (178) (0.1) (1,927) (0.5) --------- ------ -------- ------ Pre-tax income $ 13,780 4.6% $ 17,729 4.8% ========= ====== ======== ====== Net sales were $372,724 in fiscal 2002, a 25.2% increase from net sales of $297,702 in fiscal 2001. Mobile and consumer electronics' sales increased over last year, partially offset by a decrease in Sound and other. Mobile electronics increased $71,621 (45.4%) during 2002 from 2001. Sales of Mobile Video within the Mobile Electronics category increased over 59% in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001 as a result of the introduction of new video digital product, satellite radio and navigation products. 50
Consumer Electronics increased $6,092 (7.6%) to $86,472 in fiscal 2002 from $80,380 in fiscal 2001, primarily in sales of video-in-a-bag and portable DVD players. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in the sound category, particularly AV and Prestige audio lines. Given change in the marketplace, fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line. There was also an increase in sales incentives of $2,190 due to an increase in sales as compared to the prior year in the consumer goods category, which requires more promotion support. As many sales incentive programs are based on a percentage of sales, the increase in sales resulted in an increase in sales incentives. Net sales in the Company's Malaysian subsidiary decreased from last year by approximately $933 (7.4%) primarily from lower OEM business. The Company's Venezuelan subsidiary experienced a decrease of $5,823 (39.2%) in sales from last year, primarily from lower OEM business and the impact of economic and political instability in the country. Gross profit margins decreased to 16.1% in fiscal 2002 from 16.5% in fiscal 2001 despite an increase in sales. The gross margin decreased in Sound, partially offset by an increase in Mobile Electronics and international operations. Also affecting margins was the integration of Code Systems into the Electronics Group (see Note 6). During 2002, the Company was in the process of converting Code from their own domestic manufacturing to having products produced by overseas vendors. As a result, Code's gross margins were significantly lower than other product lines in the Electronics Group. Lower margins from Code were partially offset by higher margins in new models of consumer and mobile electronics. This integration of Code has been completed. Operating expenses increased $5,251 in fiscal 2002, a 14.9% increase from operating expenses in fiscal 2001. As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses decreased to 10.8% during fiscal 2002 compared to 11.8% in fiscal 2001. Selling expenses increased $1,495 during fiscal 2002, primarily in commissions of $911 due to increased commissionable sales in the video and consumer goods product categories, which has a different commission rate structure and grew faster than other product groups, salaries of $598 primarily due to Code, a new company, newly hired international salesmen and travel and entertainment of $144 due to increased travel to support increased business both in the Segment's core business and its two subsidiaries, American Radio and Code. These increases were partially offset by decreases of $262 in advertising and trade shows. General and administrative expenses increased $3,753 from fiscal 2001, mostly in salaries of $1,713 primarily due to Code, increased bonuses due to sales increases and increased head count, travel and entertainment of $234 due to additional business and acquisitions, office expenses of $122 due to increased use of employment agencies, for additional staff to support sales growth, equipment repair of $101 due to increased maintenance of office equipment, insurance expense of $378 due to higher premiums on general liability and Ocean Cargo as shipments and sales have increased, professional fees of $589 due to litigation expenses related to royalties and other matters and increased use of consulting services related to a new customer's navigation system, occupancy costs of $260 due to relocation of the display department to another separate facility, bad debt expense of $311 due to non-payment by an international customer, which is not indicative of a trend, and depreciation and amortization of $163 due to general expansion of the facilities to support the growing operations. These increases were partially offset by decreases in equipment rentals of $111 due to the elimination of certain office machines. Warehousing and technical support expenses remained essentially unchanged at $1,137 in fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001 compared to $1,134 in fiscal 2002. Pre-tax income for fiscal 2002 was $17,729, compared to $13,780 for fiscal 2001. 51
The Company believes that the Electronics Group has an expanding market with a certain level of volatility related to both domestic and international new car sales and general economic conditions. Also, all of its products are subject to price fluctuations which could affect the carrying value of inventories and gross margins in the future. OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE Interest expense and bank charges decreased $1,703 during fiscal 2002 from fiscal 2001, primarily due to lower interest rates on lower borrowing levels. Equity in income of equity investees decreased by approximately $1,807 for fiscal 2002 compared to fiscal 2001. The majority of the decrease was due to a decrease in the equity income of ASA due to a general slow down in the market for their products. Other expenses increased as a result of foreign exchange translation in our Venezuelan subsidiary as a result of the devaluation of the Venezuelan currency against the U.S. Dollar and the effects of the change from hyper-inflationary accounting for foreign exchange translation to non-hyper-inflationary accounting in fiscal 2002. During fiscal 2001, the Company accounted for foreign exchange translation in its Venezuelan subsidiary under hyper- inflationary method. The foreign exchange losses were $333 in 2001 and $2,819 in 2002. In addition, the Company recorded an other-than-temporary impairment for investment in common stock of Shintom Co., Ltd. of $1,158. The Company also recognized a gain of $14,269 on the sale of ACC shares to Toshiba (Note 3). PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES The effective tax rate for 2001 was a (benefit) of (31.6%) as compared to the effective tax rate for 2002 which was an expense of 202.0%. The increase in the effective tax rate is principally due to the increase in valuation allowance, relating to various deferred tax assets. Effective May 29, 2002, the Company's ownership in the Wireless Group was decreased to 75% (see Note 3). As such, the Company now files two consolidated U.S. Federal tax returns, one for the Wireless Group and one for the Electronics Group. As a result, the realizability of the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets are assessed on a stand-alone basis. The Company's Wireless Group has incurred cumulative losses in recent years and therefore based upon these cumulative losses and other material factors (including the Wireless Group's inability to reasonably and accurately estimate future operating and taxable income based upon the volatility of their historical operations), the Company has determined that it is more likely than not that some of the benefits of the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets and carryforwards will expire unused, accordingly, the Company has recorded an additional valuation allowance of $13,090 during fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Wireless Group's deferred tax assets. The increase in the valuation allowance relates principally to the deferred tax assets of the Wireless segment, which has recorded cumulative losses in recent years, and to certain state net operating losses which the Company has determined are more likely than not to expire unused. FISCAL 2000 (AS RESTATED) COMPARED TO FISCAL 2001 (AS RESTATED) CONSOLIDATED RESULTS Net sales for fiscal 2001 were $1,276,591, a 23.6% decrease from net sales of $1,670,291 in fiscal 2000. Wireless Group sales were $978,888 in fiscal year 2001, a 29.8% decrease from sales 52
of $1,393,820 in fiscal 2000. Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased 21.4% to approximately 7,000,000 units in fiscal 2001 from approximately 8,909,000 units in fiscal 2000. The average selling price of the Company's handsets decreased to $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 from $150 per unit in fiscal 2000 due to the introduction of newer digital models and the change of technology from analog to digital. Electronics Group sales were $297,702 in fiscal 2001, an 7.7% increase from sales of $276,471 in fiscal 2000. This increase was largely due to increased sales in the mobile video and consumer electronics product lines. Offsetting some of this increase were sound sales, which continue to decline given the change in the marketplace as fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory, rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line. Sales by the Company's international subsidiaries increased 6.2% in fiscal 2001 to approximately $28.0 million, primarily due to a 41.7% increase in Venezuela due to increasing OEM sales, partially offset by a 17.8% decrease in Malaysia from declining OEM sales. Sales were impacted by decreased sales incentives of $4,288, primarily in the Wireless Group. Without this decrease in sales incentives, sales would have decreased 23.3% in 2001 from 2000. Gross profit margin for fiscal 2001 was 5.6%, compared to 7.1% in fiscal 2000. This decline in profit margin resulted primarily from $20,650 of inventory write-downs to market and margin reductions in Wireless attributable to increased sales of digital products, which have lower margins offset by the reimbursement of $4,550 received from a manufacturer for software upgrades. A portion of the write-down of $13,500 was related to the analog write-down which was recorded in the second quarter. A majority of the analog product was sold to customers in Latin America at a price higher than the write-down and had a favorable impact on the Wireless Group's gross profit for the third quarter. This improved reported third quarter consolidated margins of 10.8% by 0.6% from 10.2% and 0.8% for the Wireless segment which reported margins 5.9% as compared to 5.1% without the recovery. Due to specific technical requirements of individual carrier customers, carriers place large purchase commitments for digital handsets with Wireless, which results in a lower selling price which then lowers gross margins. Consolidated gross margins were also favorably impacted by decreased sales incentives, principally in the Wireless Group, as there were fewer incentive programs. Operating expenses increased $1,630 in fiscal 2001, compared to fiscal 2000. As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 6.3% in fiscal 2001 from 4.7% in fiscal 2000. Major components of this increase were professional fees, salaries and commissions. Operating loss for fiscal 2001 was $9,237, compared to operating income of $39,629 in 2000. During 2000, the Company also recorded an extraordinary gain of $2,189 in connection with the extinguishment of debt. Net loss for fiscal 2001 was $7,198 compared to net income of $27,492 in fiscal 2000. Loss per share was $(0.33), basic and diluted for fiscal 2001 compared to $1.19, basic, and $1.12, diluted, and $1.29, basic and $1.22, diluted after extraordinary item, in fiscal 2000. 53
WIRELESS RESULTS The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of operations data for Wireless expressed as a percentage of net sales: 2000 2001 ------ ----- As Restated As Restated ------------------------------ ------------------------------ Net sales: Wireless products $1,359,366 97.5% $ 948,921 96.9% Activation commissions 28,983 2.1 26,879 2.8 Residual fees 1,852 0.1 2,396 0.2 Other 3,619 0.3 692 0.1 ---------- ----- --------- ----- Total net sales 1,393,820 100.0 978,888 100.0 Gross profit 69,365 5.0 21,980 2.2 Operating expenses Selling 13,609 1.0 13,108 1.3 General and administrative 15,183 1.1 16,077 1.6 Warehousing and technical support 2,691 0.2 2,761 0.3 ---------- ----- --------- ----- Total operating expenses 31,483 2.3 31,946 3.2 ---------- ----- --------- ----- Operating income (loss) 37,882 2.7 (9,966) (1.0) Other expense (7,663) (0.5) (7,690) (0.8) ---------- ----- --------- ----- Pre-tax income (loss) $ 30,219 2.2% $ (17,656) (1.8)% ========== ====== ========= ===== Net sales were $978,888 in fiscal 2001, a decrease of $414,932, or 29.8%, from fiscal 2000. Unit sales of wireless handsets decreased by 1,909,000 units in fiscal 2001, or 21.4%, to approximately 7,000,000 units from 8,909,000 units in fiscal 2000. This decrease was attributable to decreased sales of both analog and digital handsets which was due to delayed digital product acceptances by our customers, the change in technology from analog to digital and overall slower sales. The average selling price of handsets decreased to $127 per unit in fiscal 2001 from $150 per unit in fiscal 2000. During 2000, Wireless adjusted the carrying value of its analog inventory by recording write-downs to market of $8,152. During 2001, the Company recorded total inventory write-downs to market of $20,650. During the second quarter of 2001, the Company recorded an additional inventory write down of $13,500 also pertaining to its analog inventory. (See Consolidated Results, Page 46). As a result of increasing pricing pressures and a surplus of supply created by other manufacturers also attempting to sell off analog inventories, there was a drop off in demand for analog products during the second quarter. The write down was based upon the drop in demand, as carriers no longer promoted analog product and notified the Company that previous indications for orders of analog phones were no longer viable, and the continued decline in analog selling prices. There was a decrease in sales incentives of $5,850 due to lower sales and the changeover to digital products from analog products. During the fourth quarter of 2001, the Company recorded an inventory write-down of $7,150 pertaining to its digital inventory due to older technology which is to be replaced during fiscal 2002. This write-down was made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent 54
to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations. During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a reduction to cost of sales of approximately $4,550 for reimbursement from a manufacturer for upgrades performed in 2001 on certain digital phones which partially offset the decline in margins. Without this reimbursement, gross margins would have been lower by 0.5%. There were no upgrades performed in 2000. During 2001 and 2000, Wireless recorded $4,550 and $0 of price protection. Without this price protection, gross margins would have been lower by 0.5% in 2001. As of November 30, 2001, the Company had 871,000 units of inventory previously written-down with an extended value, after write-down, of $118,500. The Company sold all but 3,500 units during fiscal 2002. Operating expenses increased to $31,946 in fiscal 2001 from $31,483 in fiscal 2000. As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 3.3% during fiscal 2001 compared to 2.3% in fiscal 2000. Selling expenses decreased $501 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily in advertising of $776 due to discounted advertising costs and reimbursement from various carriers . This decrease was partially offset by an increase in commissions of $268. Commissions increased by $268 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001, which was not consistent with the change in sales. This increase was primarily due to a higher analog commission on sales of analog products sold in Mexico. As analog programs were canceled with the major wireless carriers in the United States, the Company offered a higher commission to sell the analog models quickly. General and administrative expenses increased $895 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000. Professional fees increased $1,164 due to litigation expenses. Office salaries increased by approximately $158, and travel expense increased by approximately $54 during fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to increased travel by senior executives and engineers for meetings with overseas vendors regarding new product developments. The increase in travel expense was offset by a reduction in travel expenses resulting from the closing of certain small Quintex retail locations. Corporate allocations increased $967 for additional support for the growing business for MIS and computer services. The increase was offset by a decrease in bad debt expense by $1,317, primarily due to a significant bad debt recorded in fiscal 2000 (one customer that ultimately went out of business) that did not recur to the same extent in 2001. The Company does not expect the decrease to continue given the volatility in the marketplace and the overall downturn in economic conditions. Warehousing and technical support expenses increased $70 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily in travel of $105 by our engineering department for product testing and compliance. Numerous other individually insignificant fluctuations in warehousing and technical support accounted for the remaining net decrease of $35. Pre-tax loss for fiscal 2001 was $17,656, a decrease of $47,875 from fiscal 2000. Management believes that the wireless industry is extremely competitive and that this competition could affect gross margins and the carrying value of inventories in the future as new competitors enter the marketplace. This pressure from increased competition is further enhanced by the consolidation of many of Wireless' customers into a smaller group, dominated by only a few, large customers. Also, timely delivery and carrier acceptance of new product could affect our quarterly performance. Our suppliers have to continually add new products in order for Wireless to improve its margins and gain market share. These new products require extensive testing and software development which could delay entry into the market and affect our sales in the future. (See Business Overview, page 37.) In addition, given the anticipated emergence of new technologies in the wireless industry, the Company will need to sell existing inventory quantities of current technologies to avoid further write-downs to market. 55
ELECTRONICS RESULTS The following table sets forth for the fiscal years indicated certain statements of income data for the Electronics Group expressed as a percentage of net sales: 2000 2001 ------ ----- As Restated As Restated --------------------------- ------------------------ Net sales: Mobile electronics $134,563 48.7% $157,706 53.0% Sound 77,412 28.0 57,456 19.3 Consumer electronics 60,547 21.9 80,380 27.0 Other 3,949 1.4 2,160 0.7 -------- ----- --------- ----- Total net sales 276,471 100.0 297,702 100.0 Gross profit 49,960 18.1 49,088 16.5 Operating expenses Selling 13,114 4.8 14,449 4.9 General and administrative 17,618 6.4 19,547 6.6 Warehousing and technical support 639 0.2 1,134 0.3 -------- ----- --------- ----- Total operating expenses 31,371 11.4 35,130 11.8 -------- ----- --------- ----- Operating income 18,589 6.7 13,958 4.7 Other expense (1,937) (0.7) (178) (0.1) -------- ----- --------- ----- Pre-tax income $ 16,652 6.0% $ 13,780 4.6% ======== ===== ========= ===== Net sales were $297,702 in fiscal 2001, an 7.7% increase from net sales of $276,471 in fiscal 2000, net of reversals of $1,814 and $1,083 for sales incentive programs in 2001 and 2000, respectively. Mobile and consumer electronics' sales increased over last year, partially offset by a decrease in sound. Mobile electronics increased $23,143 (17.2%) during 2001 from 2000. Sales of mobile video within the mobile electronics category increased over 27% in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000. Consumer electronics increased 32.8% to $80,380 in fiscal 2001 from $60,547 in fiscal 2000. These increases were due to the introduction of new product lines in both categories. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in the sound category, particularly SPS, AV, private label and Prestige audio lines. Given the change in the marketplace, fully-featured sound systems are being incorporated into vehicles at the factory rather than being sold in the aftermarket. This declining trend in sound systems is expected to continue except in the satellite radio product line. There was also an increase in sales incentives of $1,562 primarily due to the increase in mobile video sales. Gross profit margins decreased to 16.5% in fiscal 2001 from 18.1% in fiscal 2000, primarily in Prestige Audio and international operations, partially offset by a decrease in AV, Private Label and Security. During fiscal 2001, there was a decrease in sales incentive expense of $1,814, due to changes in the estimated amount due under accrued sales incentive programs. Operating expenses increased by $3,759 in fiscal 2001, a 12.0% increase from operating expenses of $31,371 in fiscal 2000. As a percentage of net sales, operating expenses increased to 11.8% during 56
fiscal 2001 compared to 11.3% in fiscal 2000. Selling expenses increased $1,335 during fiscal 2001, primarily in commissions and advertising. Commissions increased by approximately $1,266 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001. The increase in commissions was not consistent with the increase in sales due to a change in the mix of consumer goods and mobile video products sold which have varying commission rates. Advertising and trade show expense increased by approximately $581 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 as more products were sold in the consumer and mobile electronics category which require more advertising to create a demand among end users. These new products include mobile video, portable DVD's, navigation systems and mobile security products. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in salesmen salaries of $578 due to the restructuring of salesmen's base salaries and the downsizing of some sales offices. General and administrative expenses increased $1,929 from fiscal 2000, mostly in office salaries, insurance, bad debt, depreciation and amortization. Office salaries increased approximately $450 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 primarily due to additional employees hired to support the growth of the Electronics business. Insurance expense increased approximately $248 due to an increase in insurance rates, primarily in ocean cargo and general liability. Depreciation and amortization expense increased approximately $123 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 as a result of a full year of depreciation on fixed asset additions incurred in the prior year. Bad debt expense increased by approximately $333 from fiscal 2000 to fiscal 2001 due to two specific bad debts that occurred in fiscal 2001 that did not occur in fiscal 2000. The Company does not expect the increase to continue given that these were two specific customers, with which the Company no longer does business. Other increases were in professional fees of $105 due to legal expenses and increased corporate allocation of $1,093 for additional support for the growing business. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in temporary help of $303, as new employees were hired to support the growing business. Warehousing and technical support expenses increased $495 in fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to direct labor. Direct labor expense increased by approximately $560 as a result of increased sales. This was partially offset by a decrease of $62 in engineering department travel. Pre-tax income for fiscal 2001 was $13,780, a decrease of $2,872 from fiscal 2000. The Company believes that the Electronics Group has an expanding market with a certain level of volatility related to both domestic and international new car sales and general economic conditions. Also, certain of its products are subject to price fluctuations which could affect the carrying value of inventories and gross margins in the future. OTHER INCOME AND EXPENSE Interest expense and bank charges decreased $388 during fiscal 2001 from fiscal 2000, primarily due to decreased interest rates on similar borrowing levels. Equity in income of equity investees increased by approximately $1,014 for fiscal 2001 compared to fiscal 2000. The majority of the increase was due to increases in the equity income of ASA due to increased sales in the specialized vehicle market. Other expenses increased as a result of foreign exchange translation in our Venezuelan subsidiary as a result of the devaluation of the Venezuelan currency against the U.S. Dollar (see Note 2(d)). PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES The effective tax expense rate for 2000 was 37.4%. The effective tax benefit rate in 2001 was 31.6%. The decrease in the effective tax rate is due to the Company having a loss in 2001 for federal purposes combined with state tax expense on certain profitable subsidiaries. 57
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES The Company has historically financed its operations primarily through a combination of available borrowings under bank lines of credit and debt and equity offerings. As of November 30, 2002, the Company had working capital (defined as current assets less current liabilities) of $292,687, which includes cash of $2,758 compared with working capital of $284,166 at November 30, 2001, which includes cash of $3,025. Operating activities provided approximately $24,070 in fiscal 2002 as compared to a cash usage of $74,076 in fiscal 2001, primarily from a decrease in accounts receivable of $48,555 due to lower sales and better cash collections, an increase in accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities due to new trade terms from vendor, offset by an increase in inventory due to cancellation of certain orders in the Electronics Group and new products in Wireless slated for shipment in 2003. Investing activities provided approximately $20,090, primarily from proceeds from the issuance of subsidiary shares, partially offset by the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc. Financing activities used approximately $44,198, primarily for repayments to bank institutions. The Company's Board of Directors approved the repurchase of 1,563,000 shares of the Company's Class A common stock in the open market under a share repurchase program (the Program). As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 909,537 and 1,072,737 shares, respectively, were repurchased under the Program at an average price of $8.12 and $7.93 per share, respectively, for an aggregate amount of $7,386 and $8,511, respectively. In February 2000, the Company completed a follow on offering of 3,565,000 Class A common shares at a price to the public of $45.00 per share. Of the 3,565,000 shares sold, the Company offered 2,300,000 shares and 1,265,000 shares were offered by selling shareholders. Audiovox received approximately $96,573 after deducting expenses. The Company used these net proceeds to repay a portion of amounts outstanding under their revolving credit facility, any portion of which can be reborrowed at any time. The Company did not receive any of the net proceeds from the sale of shares by the selling shareholders. The Company's principal source of liquidity is its revolving credit agreement which expires July 27, 2004 and cash flows from operations. Subsequent to year-end, the Company requested a reduction of available credit from $250,000 to $200,000. This is a result of excess bank availability being reduced to limit paid fees on unused portions of bank availability. The credit agreement was amended on March 13, 2003 and provides for $200,000 of available credit, including $15,000 for foreign currency borrowings. The continued availability of this financing is dependent upon the Company's operating results and borrowing base which would be negatively impacted by a decrease in demand for the Company's products. Under the credit agreement, the Company may obtain credit through direct borrowings and letters of credit. The obligations of the Company under the credit agreement are guaranteed by certain of the Company's subsidiaries and is secured by accounts receivable and inventory. As of November 30, 2002, availability under this line of credit is subject to certain conditions, based upon a formula taking into account the amount and quality of its accounts receivable and inventory. At November 58
30, 2002, the amount of unused available credit is $102,491. The credit agreement also allows for commitments up to $50,000 in forward exchange contracts. In addition, the Company guarantees the borrowings of one of its equity investees at a maximum of $300. The credit agreement contains several covenants requiring, among other things, minimum levels of pre-tax income and minimum levels of net worth. Additionally, the agreement includes restrictions and limitations on payments of dividends, stock repurchases and capital expenditures. At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants. Furthermore, as of November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year-end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company's quarter end. The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations. The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year-end. Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company's outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively. Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations. While the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0. This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below. The Company also has revolving credit facilities in Malaysia to finance additional working capital needs. As of November 30, 2002, the available line of credit for direct borrowing, letters of credit, bankers' acceptances and other forms of credit approximately $5,000. The Malaysian credit facilities are partially secured by the Company under three standby letters of credit of $1,300, $800 and $800 and are payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letters of credit which expire on December 31, 2002, August 31, 2003 and August 31, 2003, respectively. The obligations of the Company under the Malaysian credit facilities are secured by the property and building in Malaysia owned by Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. The Company also has a revolving credit facility in Brazil to finance additional working capital needs. The Brazilian credit facility is secured by the Company under a standby letter of credit in the amount of $200, which expires on January 15, 2003 and is payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit. At November 30, 2002, outstanding obligations under the credit facility were 172 Brazilian Bolivars ($47), and interest on the credit facility ranged from 19% to 29%. Total debt as a percent of total capitalization was 20% at November 30, 2002 as compared with 33% at November 30, 2001, primarily as a result of lower outstanding indebtedness. 59
At November 30, 2002, the Company had additional outstanding standby letters of credit aggregating $640 which expire in July 2004. The Company has certain contractual cash obligations and other commercial commitments which will impact its short and long-term liquidity. At November 30, 2002, such obligations and commitments are as follows: Payments Due By Period ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ Less than Over Contractual Cash Obligations Total 1 Year 1-3 Years 4-5 Years 5 Years - ---------------------------- ----- -------- --------- --------- ------- Capital lease obligations $ 14,206 $ 554 $ 1,666 $ 1,157 $10,829 Operating leases 6,680 1,983 2,359 1,449 889 -------- -------- -------- ------- ------- Total contractual cash obligations $ 20,886 $ 2,537 $ 4,025 $ 2,606 $11,718 ======== ======= ======= ======= ======= Amount of Commitment Expiration per period ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Total Other Commercial Amounts Less than Over Commitments Committed 1 Year 1-3 Years 4-5 Years 5 years - ------------- --------- -------- --------- --------- ------- Lines of credit $ 40,248 $ 40,248 - - - Standby letters of credit 3,740 3,740 - - - Guarantees 300 300 - - - Commercial letters of credit 8,129 8,129 - - - -------- -------- --------- -------- -------- Total commercial commitments $ 52,417 $ 52,417 - - - ======== ======== ========= ======== ======== The Company regularly reviews its cash funding requirements and attempts to meet those requirements through a combination of cash on hand, cash provided by operations, available borrowings under bank lines of credit and possible future public or private debt and/or equity offerings. At times, the Company evaluates possible acquisitions of, or investments in, businesses that are complementary to those of the Company, which transaction may require the use of cash. The Company believes that its cash, other liquid assets, operating cash flows, credit arrangements, access to equity capital markets, taken together, provide adequate resources to fund ongoing operating expenditures. In the event that they do not, the Company may require additional funds in the future to support its working capital requirements or for other purposes and may seek to raise such additional funds through the sale of public or private equity and/or debt financings as well as from other sources. No assurance can be given that additional financing will be available in the future or that if available, such financing will be obtainable on terms favorable to the Company when required. In February 2003, the Company entered into an agreement to buy a building for expansion purposes for $3,480, made a deposit of $348 and expects to close in the very near term. 60
In May 2003, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to buy certain assets of Recoton Corporation. In accordance with the agreement, the Company made a deposit of $2,000, which is currently being held in escrow. The Company is awaiting final approval of this purchase from a bankruptcy court. This purchase would amount to approximately $40,000 plus the assumption of $5,000 in debt, not including related acquisition costs. The Company anticipates using its existing cash and available financing to fund this acquisition. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS The Company has entered into several related party transactions which are described below. Leasing Transactions During 1998, the Company entered into a 30-year capital lease for a building with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer, which is the headquarters of the Wireless operation. Payments on the lease were based upon the construction costs of the building and the then-current interest rates. The effective interest rate on the capital lease obligation is 8%. In connection with the capital lease, the Company paid certain costs on behalf of its principal stockholder and chief executive officer in the amount of $1,301. The advance does not have a specified due date or interest rate. During 2001 and 2002, the entire balance of $1,301 was repaid to the Company. During 1998, the Company entered into a sale/leaseback transaction with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer for $2,100 of equipment, which has been classified as an operating lease. The lease is a five-year lease with monthly payments of $34. No gain or loss was recorded on the transaction as the book value of the equipment equaled the fair market value. The Company also leases certain facilities from its principal stockholder. Rentals for such leases are considered by management of the Company to approximate prevailing market rates. Total lease payments required under the leases for the five-year period ending November 30, 2007 are $2,739. Amounts Due from Officers A note due from an officer/director of the Company, which bore interest at the LIBOR rate, to be adjusted quarterly, plus 1.25% per annum, was paid in full during fiscal 2002. In addition, the Company has outstanding notes due from various officers of the Company aggregating $235 as of November 30, 2002, which have been included in prepaid expenses and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet. The notes bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 0.5% per annum. Principal and interest are payable in equal annual installments beginning July 1, 1999 through July 1, 2003. In accordance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the Company will not alter the terms of the notes and all amounts will be repaid in full in July 2003. In addition, no new notes with officers or directors of the Company will be entered into. Transactions with Shintom and TALK In April 2000, AX Japan purchased land and a building (the Property) from Shintom Co., Ltd. (Shintom) for 770,000,000 Yen (approximately $7,300) and entered into a leaseback agreement whereby Shintom has leased the Property from AX Japan for a one-year period. This lease is being accounted for as an operating lease by AX Japan. Shintom is a stockholder who owns all of the outstanding preferred stock of the Company and is a manufacturer of products purchased by the Company through its previously- owned equity investment, TALK Corporation (TALK). The Company currently holds stock in Shintom and has previously invested in Shintom convertible debentures. The purchase of the Property by AX Japan was financed with a 500,000,000 Yen ($4,671) subordinated loan obtained from Vitec Co., Ltd. (Vitec), a 150,000,000 Yen loan ($1,397) from Pearl First (Pearl) and a 140,000,000 Yen loan ($1,291) from the Company. The land and building have 61
been included in property, plant and equipment, and the loans have been recorded as notes payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002 . Vitec is a major supplier to Shintom, and Pearl is an affiliate of Vitec. The loans bear interest at 5% per annum, and principle is payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning six months subsequent to the date of the loans. The loans from Vitec and Pearl are subordinated completely to the loan from the Company and, in liquidation, the Company receives payment first. Upon the expiration of six months after the transfer of the title to the Property to AX Japan, Shintom has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan. These options can be extended for one additional six month period. The option to repurchase the building is at a price of 770,000,000 Yen plus the equity capital of AX Japan (which in no event can be less than 60,000,000 Yen) and can only be made if Shintom settles any rent due AX Japan pursuant to the lease agreement. The option to purchase the shares of stock of AX Japan is at a price not less than the aggregate par value of the shares and, subsequent to the purchase of the shares, AX Japan must repay the outstanding loan due to the Company. If Shintom does not exercise its option to repurchase the Property or the shares of AX Japan, or upon occurrence of certain events, AX Japan can dispose of the Property as it deems appropriate. The events which result in the ability of AX Japan to be able to dispose of the Property include Shintom petitioning for bankruptcy, failing to honor a check, failing to pay rent, etc. If Shintom fails, or at any time becomes financially or otherwise unable to exercise its option to repurchase the Property, Vitec has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan under similar terms as the Shintom options. In connection with this transaction, the Company received 100,000,000 Yen ($922) from Shintom for its 2,000 shares of TALK stock. The Company had the option to repurchase the shares of TALK at a purchase price of 50,000 Yen per share, with no expiration date. Given the option to repurchase the shares of TALK, the Company did not surrender control over the shares of TALK and, accordingly, had not accounted for this transaction as a sale. In August 2000, the Company surrendered its option to repurchase the shares of TALK. As such, the Company recorded a gain on the sale of shares in the amount of $427 in August 2000. AX Japan had the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its options to repurchase the Property or stock of AX Japan. In September 2000, Shintom extended its option to repurchase the Property and AX Japan delayed its repayment of the loans for an additional six months. In October 2002, the Company sold all of its shares in AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., an unrelated party to the Company. The purchase price of the shares was 60,000 Yen. As a result of this transaction, the purchaser repaid in full 113,563 Yen which represented the full balance of amounts then owed to the Company by AX Japan. The agreement required the purchaser to immediately change the name of AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., and the Company resigned from all officer and Board of Directors positions. The Company has no further relationship or obligations, whether contingent or direct, to RMS Co., Ltd., formerly known as AX Japan. As a result of the completion of this transaction, all assets and liabilities of Audiovox Japan have been removed from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002, specifically, the land and the building and the notes payable for the Vitec Co., Ltd (Vitec) 150,000 Yen loan and the Pearl First (Pearl) a 140,000 Yen loan. As a result of this transaction, the Company recovered in Yen its initial investment in AX Japan as well as its loan to finance the purchase of the 62
land and building. However, the Company recognized a $338 loss on the sale of its shares in AX Japan, as the sales price was less than the value of the net assets of AX Japan sold to Vitec. Contributing to the loss on sale were foreign currency loss and other expenses that will not be recovered. The loss on the sale of the shares of AX Japan has been included in other net on the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002. The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK. TALK, which holds world-wide distribution rights for product manufactured by Shintom, has given the Company exclusive distribution rights on all wireless personal communication products for all countries except Japan, China, Thailand and several mid-eastern countries. Through October 2000, the Company held a 30.8% interest in TALK. The Company no longer holds an equity interest in TALK. Transactions with Shintom and TALK include financing arrangements and inventory purchases which approximated 7%, 1.5% and 0.7% for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, of total inventory purchases. At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded $1, $331 and $0, respectively, of liability due to TALK for inventory purchases included in accounts payable. There were no documentary acceptance obligations payable to TALK as of November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded a receivable from TALK in the amount of $3,823, $265 and $13, respectively, a portion of which is payable with interest, which is reflected in receivable from vendors on the accompanying consolidated financial statements. During 2002, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $1,158 on the 634,666 shares owned at November 30, 2002. Transactions with Toshiba On March 31, 1999, Toshiba purchased 5% of the Company's subsidiary, ACC, a supplier of wireless products for $5,000 in cash. The Company then owned 95% of ACC; prior to the transaction ACC was a wholly-owned subsidiary. In February 2001, the Board of Directors of ACC, declared a dividend payable to its shareholders, Audiovox Corporation, a then 95% shareholder, and Toshiba, a then 5% shareholder. ACC paid Toshiba its share of the dividend, which approximated $1,034 in the first quarter of 2001. The dividend equaled 5.0% of ACC's prior year net income. There were no dividends declared during 2002, due to the net loss of ACC during 2001. During the second quarter of 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC. Under the terms of the transaction, Toshiba acquired, in exchange for $23,900 cash, the additional shares of ACC. In addition, Toshiba paid $8,100 in exchange for an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) due from ACC. The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1 3/4% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003. The unpaid principal amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest on May 31, 2007 which will automatically renew for an additional five years. In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may, at any time, convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a 25% maximum interest in ACC. The cost per share of the note is equal to the per share cost for the $23,900 cash payment of 20% of ACC's shares. In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba entered into a distribution agreement whereby ACC will be Toshiba's exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007. The distribution agreement established certain annual minimum purchase targets for ACC's purchase of Toshiba products for each fiscal year during the entire term of the agreement. In the event that ACC fails to meet the minimum purchase target, Toshiba shall have the right to convert ACC's exclusive distributorship to a non-exclusive distributorship for the remaining term of the agreement. 63
Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement, Toshiba maintains a put right and Audiovox Corp. a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated in accordance with the agreement. Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company. The call right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial five (5) year term. Additionally in connection with the transaction, ACC entered into an employment agreement with the President and Chief Executive Officer (the Executive) of ACC through May 29, 2007. Under the agreement, ACC is required to pay the Executive an annual base salary of $500 in addition to an annual bonus equal to 2% of ACC's annual earnings before income taxes. Audiovox Corp., under the employment agreement, was required to establish and pay a bonus of $3,200 to key employees of ACC, including the Executive, to be allocated by the Executive. The bonus was for services previously rendered in connection with the Toshiba purchase of additional shares of ACC, and, accordingly, the bonus has been included in general and administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002. The Executive was required to utilize all or a portion of the bonus allocated to him to repay the remaining outstanding principal and accrued interest owed by the Executive to the Company pursuant to the unsecured promissory note in favor of Audiovox Corp. During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Executive was paid $1,800 less the amount outstanding under the promissory note of $651. As a result of the issuance of ACC's shares, the Company recognized a gain, net of expenses of $1,735, of $14,269 ($8,847 after provision for deferred taxes). The gain on the issuance of the subsidiary's shares has been recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. Inventory on hand at November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002 purchased from Toshiba approximated $99,816 and $138,467, respectively. During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a receivable in the amount of $4,550 from Toshiba for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured. The amount was received in full during the first quarter of 2002. At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, these amounts were paid in full. At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand 504,020 units in the amount of $91,226, which were purchased from Toshiba and have been recorded in inventory and accounts payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet. Of this accounts payable, $56,417 was subject to an arrangement with Toshiba, which provides for, among other things, extended payment terms. This arrangement has since been modified in an effort to enhance the Company's relationship with Toshiba. The payment terms are such that the payable is non-interest bearing. The remaining 34,809 of the $91,226 accounts payable is payable in accordance with the terms established in the distribution agreement, which is 30 days. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company paid this amount in full. Under the above arrangement, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from Toshiba. The Company will record such price protection, if necessary, at the time of the sale of the units. The Company had no other amounts outstanding to Toshiba at November 30, 2002. 64
IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CURRENCY FLUCTUATION Inflation has not had a significant impact on the Company's financial position or operating results other than the effect of our 80%-owned Venezuelan subsidiary ceasing to be considered a highly- inflationary economy in fiscal 2002. To the extent that the Company expands its operations into Latin America and the Pacific Rim, the effects of inflation and currency fluctuations in those areas could have growing significance to its financial condition and results of operations. Fluctuations in the foreign exchange rates in Pacific Rim countries have not had a material adverse effect on the Company's consolidated financial position, results of operations or liquidity. While the prices that the Company pays for the products purchased from its suppliers are principally denominated in United States dollars, price negotiations depend in part on the relationship between the foreign currency of the foreign manufacturers and the United States dollar. This relationship is dependent upon, among other things, market, trade and political factors. Inflation-related accounting adjustments of $333 were made for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2001, related to the Company's operations in Venezuela. Inflation-related accounting adjustments of $1,712 were made for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002 related to the Company's operations in Venezuela. This increase is a result of Venezuela no longer being deemed a hyper-inflationary economy as of the first quarter of fiscal 2002. On January 22, 2003, and as a result of the National Civil Strike, the Venezuelan government suspended trading of the Venezuelan Bolivar and set the currency at a stated government rate. Accordingly, until further guidance is issued, the Company's 80% owned Venezuelan subsidiary will translate its financial statements utilizing the stated government rate. SEASONALITY The Company typically experiences some seasonality in its operations. The Company generally experiences a substantial amount of its sales during September, October and November. December is also a key month for the Company due to increased demand for its products during the holiday season. This increase results from increased promotional and advertising activities from the Company's customers to end-users. RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS In July 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 141, "Business Combinations" and SFAS No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets". SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all future business combinations and specifies criteria intangible assets acquired in a business combination must meet to be recognized and reported apart from goodwill. SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead be tested for impairment at least annually in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 142. SFAS No. 142 also requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the impairment of Long-Live Assets to be Disposed Of". The Company early adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and SFAS No. 142 as of December 1, 2001. As a result of adopting the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and 142, the Company did not record 65
amortization expense relating to its goodwill during the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002, which approximated $9,616. The Company was not required under SFAS No. 142 to assess the useful life and residual value of its goodwill as the Company's goodwill is equity method goodwill and, as such, will continue to be evaluated for impairment under SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of." In July 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, "Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations" (Statement 143). Statement 143 is effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2002, and establishes an accounting standard requiring the recording of the fair value of liabilities associated with the retirement of long-lived assets in the period in which they are incurred. The Company does not expect the adoption of Statement 143 to have a significant effect on its results of operations or its financial position. In October 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 144, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets" (Statement 144), which addresses financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets. This statement supersedes Statement No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of", while retaining the fundamental recognition and measurement provisions of that statement. Statement No. 144 requires that a long-lived asset to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset or distributed to owners in a spin-off to be considered held and used until it is disposed of. However, Statement No. 144 requires that management consider revising the depreciable life of such long-lived asset. With respect to long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale, Statement No. 144 retains the provisions of Statement No. 121 and, therefore, requires that discontinued operations no longer be measured on a net realizable value basis and that future operating losses associated with such discontinued operations no longer be recognized before they occur. Statement No. 144 is effective for all fiscal quarters of fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2001 and will thus be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2002. The Company has determined that the effect of the adoption of Statement No. 144 did not have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial statements. SFAS 145 "Rescission of SFAS Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of SFAS No. 13 and Technical Corrections". This Statement updates, clarifies and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements by rescinding Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of related income tax effect. As a result, the criteria in Opinion 30 will now be used to classify those gains and losses. This statement will have no material effect on the Company's financial statements. Effective March 1, 2002, the Company adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 01-9, "Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer", which codified and reconciled the following EITF Issues: Issue No. 00-14, "Accounting for Certain Sales Incentive", Issue No. 00-22, "Accounting for Points and Certain Other Time-Based Sales Incentive Offers and Offers for Free Products or Services to be Delivered in the Future" and Issue No. 00-25, "Vendor Income Statement Characterization of Consideration Paid to a Reseller of the Vendor's Products". Issue No. 00-14 addressed when sales incentives and discounts should be recognized, as well as where the related revenues and expenses should be classified in the financial statements. Upon adoption of this Issue, the Company reclassified its sales incentives which take the form of (co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds, volume incentive rebates and other trade allowances) against net sales which were previously recorded in selling expenses. Operating income has remained unchanged by this adoption. These reclassifications have been reported in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations retroactively for all periods reported. 66
In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation - Transition and Disclosure". SFAS No. 148 provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation as originally provided by SFAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation". Additionally, SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 123 to require prominent disclosure in both annual and interim financial statements about the method of accounting for stock-based compensation and the effect of the method used on reported results. The transitional requirements of SFAS No. 148 will be effective for all financial statements for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002. The disclosure requirements shall be effective for financial reports containing condensed financial statements for interim periods beginning after December 31, 2002. The Company expects to adopt the disclosure portion of this statement for the fiscal quarter ending May 31, 2003. The application of this standard will have no impact on the Company's consolidated financial position or results of operations. In February 2003, the EITF Issued 02-16, "Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor". This EITF provides guidance on the income statement classification of amounts received by a customer, including a reseller and guidance regarding timing of recognition for volume rebates. The Company does not believe that adoption of this new standard, which will be applied prospectively by the Company for new arrangements, including modifications of existing arrangements, entered into after December 31, 2002, will have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial position or results of operations. In November 2002, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 45 (FIN 45), "Guarantor's Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantors, Including Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others". FIN 45 elaborates on the disclosures to be made by a guarantor in its interim and annual financial statements about its obligations under certain guarantees that it has issued. It also clarifies that a guarantor is required to recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee. The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of FIN 45 are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002, irrespective of the guarantor's fiscal year-end. The disclosure requirements of FIN 45 are effective for financial statements of interim or annual periods ending after December 15, 2002. The Company does not expect the adoption of FIN 45 to have a material effect on its consolidated financial position or results of operations. In January 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), "Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, an interpretation of ARB No. 51". FIN 46 addresses the consolidation by business enterprises of variable interest entities as defined in the Interpretation. FIN 46 is effective for all new variable interest entities created or acquired after January 31, 2003. For variable interest entities created or acquired prior to February 1, 2003, the provisions of FIN 46 must be applied for the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. The adoption of FIN46 is being evaluated to determine what impact, if any, the adoption of the provisions will have on the Company's financial condition or results of operations. ITEM 7a - QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK MARKET RISK SENSITIVE INSTRUMENTS The market risk inherent in the Company's market risk sensitive instruments and positions 67
is the potential loss arising from adverse changes in marketable equity security prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates. Marketable Securities Marketable securities at November 30, 2002, which are recorded at fair value of $5,405 and include net unrealized losses of $966, have exposure to price risk. This risk is estimated as the potential loss in fair value resulting from a hypothetical 10% adverse change in prices quoted by stock exchanges and amounts to $541 as of November 30, 2002. Actual results may differ. Interest Rate Risk The Company's bank loans expose earnings to changes in short-term interest rates since interest rates on the underlying obligations are either variable or fixed for such a short period of time as to effectively become variable. The fair values of the Company's bank loans are not significantly affected by changes in market interest rates. Foreign Exchange Risk In order to reduce the risk of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, the Company hedges transactions denominated in a currency other than the functional currencies applicable to each of its various entities. The instruments used for hedging are forward contracts with banks. The changes in market value of such contracts have a high correlation to price changes in the currency of the related hedged transactions. There were no hedge transactions at November 30, 2002. Intercompany transactions with foreign subsidiaries and equity investments are typically not hedged. Therefore, the potential loss in fair value for a net currency position resulting from a 10% adverse change in quoted foreign currency exchange rates as of November 30, 2002 is not applicable. The Company is subject to risk from changes in foreign exchange rates for its subsidiaries and equity investments that use a foreign currency as their functional currency and are translated into U.S. dollars. These changes result in cumulative translation adjustments which are included in accumulated other comprehensive income. On November 30, 2002, the Company had translation exposure to various foreign currencies with the most significant being the Malaysian ringgit, Thailand baht and Canadian dollar. The Company also has a Venezuelan subsidiary in which translation adjustments are included in net income. The potential loss resulting from a hypothetical 10% adverse change in quoted foreign currency exchange rates, as of November 30, 2002, amounts to $867. Actual results may differ. ITEM 8 - CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA The consolidated financial statements of the Company as of November 30, 2001 and 2002 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, together with the independent auditors' report thereon of KPMG LLP, independent auditors, are filed under this Item 8. The consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2000 have been restated as described in Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 68
Independent Auditors' Report The Board of Directors and Stockholders Audiovox Corporation: We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. As discussed in Note 1, effective December 1, 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (Statement) No. 141, "Business Combinations" and Statement No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets". As discussed in Note 2 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements, the consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 have been restated. s/KPMG LLP ------------------------ KPMG LLP Melville, New York May 30, 2003 69
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS NOVEMBER 30, 2001 AND 2002 (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 2001 2002 ---- ---- As Restated See Note (2) ASSETS Current assets: Cash $ 3,025 $ 2,758 Accounts receivable, net 238,357 186,564 Inventory, net 225,759 290,064 Receivable from vendor 6,828 14,174 Prepaid expenses and other current assets 7,639 7,626 Deferred income taxes, net 11,965 7,653 --------- --------- Total current assets 493,573 508,839 Investment securities 5,777 5,405 Equity investments 10,268 11,097 Property, plant and equipment, net 25,687 18,381 Excess cost over fair value of assets acquired and other intangible assets, net 4,742 6,826 Deferred income taxes, net 3,148 - Other assets 1,302 687 --------- --------- $ 544,497 $ 551,235 ========= ========= LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY Current liabilities: Accounts payable $ 57,162 $ 121,127 Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 42,137 34,983 Accrued sales incentives 8,474 12,151 Income taxes payable 4,154 7,643 Bank obligations 92,213 40,248 Notes payable 5,267 - --------- --------- Total current liabilities 209,407 216,152 Long-term debt - 8,140 Capital lease obligation 6,196 6,141 Deferred income taxes payable - 2,704 Deferred compensation 3,844 3,969 --------- ---------- Total liabilities 219,447 237,106 --------- ---------- Minority interest 1,830 4,616 --------- ---------- Commitments and contingencies Stockholders' equity: Preferred stock, liquidation preference of $2,500 2,500 2,500 Common stock: Class A; 60,000,000 authorized 2001 and 2002, 20,615,846 and 20,632,182 issued 2001 and 2002, respectively; 19,706,309 and 19,559,445 outstanding 2001 and 2002, respectively 207 207 Class B convertible; 10,000,000 authorized; 2,260,954 issued and outstanding 22 22 Paid-in capital 250,785 250,917 Retained earnings 83,436 69,396 Accumulated other comprehensive loss (6,344) (5,018) Treasury stock, at cost, 909,537 and 1,072,737 Class A common stock 2001 and 2002, respectively (7,386) (8,511) --------- ---------- Total stockholders' equity 323,220 309,513 --------- ---------- Total liabilities and stockholders' equity $ 544,497 $ 551,235 ========= ========== SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. 70
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS YEARS ENDED NOVEMBER 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002 (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA) 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- AS RESTATED AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- See Note (2) See Note (2) Net sales $ 1,670,291 $ 1,276,591 $ 1,100,382 Cost of sales 1,551,666 1,205,201 1,025,783 ----------- ----------- ----------- Gross profit 118,625 71,390 74,599 ----------- ----------- ----------- Operating expenses: Selling 29,056 30,039 29,509 General and administrative 46,466 46,505 55,292 Warehousing and technical support 3,474 4,082 3,874 ----------- ----------- ----------- Total operating expenses 78,996 80,626 88,675 ----------- ----------- ----------- Operating income (loss) 39,629 (9,236) (14,076) ----------- ----------- ----------- Other income (expense): Interest and bank charges (6,310) (5,922) (4,219) Equity in income of equity investees 2,572 3,586 1,779 Gain on sale of investments 2,387 - - Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities 1,499 - - Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares - - 14,269 Other, net 2,366 90 (4,156) ----------- ----------- ------------ Total other income (expense), net 2,514 (2,246) 7,673 ----------- ----------- ------------ Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 42,143 (11,482) (6,403) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes 15,766 (3,627) 12,932 Minority interest (1,074) 657 5,055 ----------- ----------- ------------ Income (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 25,303 (7,198) (14,280) Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 2,189 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill - - 240 ----------- ----------- ------------ Net income (loss) $ 27,492 $ (7,198) $ (14,040) =========== =========== ============ Netincome (loss) per common share (basic) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ 1.19 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill - - 0.01 ---------- ----------- ------------ Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ 1.29 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) ========== =========== ============ Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ 1.12 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill - - 0.01 ---------- ----------- ------------- Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ 1.22 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) ========== =========== ============= Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,393,566 21,877,100 21,850,035 ========== =========== ============= Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 22,565,806 21,877,100 21,850,035 ========== =========== ============= SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. 71
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS) YEARS ENDED NOVEMBER 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002 (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Accum- ulated Other Gain on Compre- Hedge of hensive Available Preferred Common Paid-In Retained Income for Sale Stock Stock Capital Earnings (Loss) Securities --------- ------- ------- -------- ------- ---------- Balances at November 30, 1999 2,500 201 149,278 63,142 5,165 929 Comprehensive income: Net income, as restated - - - 27,492 - - Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: - - - - - - Foreign currency translation adjustment - - - - (104) - Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(6,202) - - - - (10,119) - Other comprehensive loss - - - - - - Comprehensive income - - - - - - Exercise of stock options into 121,300 shares of comm stock and issuance of 11,671 shares under the Restricted Stock Plan - 1 836 - - - Tax benefit of stock options exercised - - 1,270 - - - Conversion of debentures into 30,170 shares - 1 534 - - - Issuance of 2,300,000 shares in connection with stock offering - 23 96,550 - - - Acquisition of 141,455 common shares - - - - - - Recognition of gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities - - - - - (929) ----- ---- ------- -------- --------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2000, as restated 2,500 226 248,468 90,634 (5,058) - Comprehensive loss: Net loss, as restated - - - (7,198) - - Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustment - - - - (455) - Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(509) - - - - (831) - Other comprehensive loss - - - - - - Comprehensive loss - - - - - - Exercise of stock options into 10,000 shares of common stock - - 77 - - - Conversion of stock warrants into 314,800 shares - 3 2,240 - - - Acquisition of 147,045 common shares - - - - - - ----- ---- ------- -------- --------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2001, as restated 2,500 229 250,785 83,436 (6,344) - Comprehensive loss: Net loss - - - (14,040) - - Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustment - - - - 904 - Unrealized gain on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $260 - - - - 422 - Other comprehensive loss - - - - - - Comprehensive loss - - - - - - Exercise of stock options into 16,336 shares of common stock - - 132 - - - Acquisition of 163,200 common shares - - - - - - ----- ---- ------- -------- --------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2002 2,500 229 250,917 69,396 (5,018) - ===== ==== ======== ======== ========= =======
Total Stock- Treasury holders' Stock Equity ----- ------- Balances at November 30, 1999 (4,471) 216,744 Comprehensive income: Net income, as restated - 27,492 Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: - Foreign currency translation adjustment - (104) Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(6,202) - (10,119) -------- Other comprehensive loss - (10,223) -------- Comprehensive income - 17,269 Exercise of stock options into 121,300 shares of common stock and issuance of 11,671 shares under the Restricted Stock Plan - 837 Tax benefit of stock options exercised - 1,270 Conversion of debentures into 30,170 shares - 535 Issuance of 2,300,000 shares in connection with stock offering - 96,573 Acquisition of 141,455 common shares (1,533) (1,533) Recognition of gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities - (929) ------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2000, as restated (6,004) 330,766 Comprehensive loss: Net loss, as restated - (7,198) Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustment - (455) Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $(509) - (831) -------- Other comprehensive loss - (1,286) -------- Comprehensive loss - (8,484) Exercise of stock options into 10,000 shares of commmon stock - 77 Conversion of stock warrants into 314,800 shares - 2,243 Acquisition of 147,045 common shares (1,382) (1,382) ------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2001, as restated (7,386) 323,220 Comprehensive loss: Net loss - (14,040) Other comprehensive loss, net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustment - 904 Unrealized gain on marketable securities, net of tax effect of $260 - 422 --------- Other comprehensive loss - 1,326 --------- Comprehensive loss - (12,714) Exercise of stock options into 16,336 shares of common stock - 132 Acquisition of 163,200 common shares (1,125) (1,125) ------- ------- Balances at November 30, 2002 (8,511) 309,513 ======= ========= SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. 72
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS YEARS ENDED NOVEMBER 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002 (IN THOUSANDS) 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- AS RESTATED AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- See Note (2) See Note (2) Cash flows from operating activities: Net income (loss) $ 27,492 $ (7,198) $ (14,040) Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash flows (used in) provided by operating activities Depreciation and amortization 4,128 4,476 4,780 Provision for bad debt expense 2,519 1,936 4,884 Equity in income of equity investments (2,572) (3,586) (1,779) Minority interest 1,074 (657) (5,055) Gain on sale of investments (427) - - Gain from the sale of shares of equity investment (2,387) - - Gain on hedge of available-for-sale securities (1,499) - - Gain on issuance of subsidiary shares - - (14,269) Other-than-temporary decline in market value of investment security - - 1,158 Deferred income tax (benefit) expense, net (6,034) (3,332) 9,904 Extraordinary item (2,189) - - (Gain) loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment, net (1) (18) (69) Income tax benefit on exercise of stock options (1,270) - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for goodwill - - (240) Changes in operating assets and liabilities: Accounts receivable (31,705) 35,797 48,555 Receivable from vendor 3,761 (1,263) (7,346) Inventory (22,333) (67,735) (64,548) Accounts payable, accrued expenses and other current liabilities 22,431 (29,745) 66,644 Income taxes payable 182 (2,979) 3,599 Investment securities-trading (2,211) (1,635) (125) Prepaid expenses and other, net 4,413 1,863 (7,983) --------- ---------- --------- Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities (6,628) (74,076) 24,070 --------- ---------- --------- Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of property, plant and equipment (13,075) (2,869) (3,159) Proceeds from the sale of property, plant and equipment 1,028 261 7,250 Net proceeds from sale of investment securities 13,227 - - Proceeds from distribution from an equity investee 1,286 4,634 947 Net proceeds from issuance of subsidiary shares - - 22,158 Proceeds from the sale of shares of equity investment 922 - - Purchase of acquired business, net of acquired cash - - (7,106) --------- ---------- --------- Net cash provided by investing activities 3,388 2,026 20,090 --------- ---------- --------- Cash flows from financing activities: Borrowings of bank obligations 918,785 901,628 403,043 Repayments on bank obligations (1,013,466) (832,329) (454,300) Proceeds from issuance of convertible subordinated debentures - - 8,107 Issuance of notes payable 5,868 - - Payment of dividend to minority shareholder of subsidiary (859) (1,034) - Net repayments under documentary acceptances (1,994) - - 73
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (CONTINUED) YEARS ENDED NOVEMBER 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002 (IN THOUSANDS) 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- AS RESTATED AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- Principal payments on capital lease obligation (19) (29) (55) Proceeds from exercise of stock options and warrants 837 2,317 132 Repurchase of Class A common stock (1,534) (1,382) (1,125) Principal payments on subordinated debt - (486) - Net proceeds from sale of common stock 96,573 - - --------- ------- ------ Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 4,198 68,685 (44,198) --------- ------- ------- Effect of exchange rate changes on cash (54) (41) (229) --------- ------- ------- Net increase (decrease) in cash 904 (3,406) (267) Cash at beginning of period 5,527 6,431 3,025 --------- ------- ------- Cash at end of period $ 6,431 $ 3,025 $ 2,758 ========= ======= ======= SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. 74
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS NOVEMBER 30, 2000, 2001 AND 2002 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE AND PER SHARE DATA) (1) Description of Business and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (a) Description of Business Audiovox Corporation and its subsidiaries (the Company) design and market a diverse line of products and provide related services throughout the world. These products and services include handsets and accessories for wireless communications, automotive entertainment and security products, automotive electronic accessories and consumer electronics. The Company operates in two primary markets (which are also the Company's reportable segments for accounting purposes): (1) Wireless communications. The Wireless Group markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers. (2) Mobile and consumer electronics. The Electronics Group sells autosound, mobile electronics and consumer electronics primarily to mass merchants, power retailers, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEMs), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military. (b) Principles of Consolidation The consolidated financial statements include the financial statements of Audiovox Corporation and its wholly-owned and majority-owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. (c) Cash Equivalents Investments with original maturities of three months or less are considered cash equivalents. There were no cash equivalents at November 30, 2001 and 2002. (d) Revenue Recognition The Company recognizes revenue from product sales at the time of passage of title and risk of loss to the customer either at FOB Shipping Point or FOB Destination, based upon terms established with the customer. Any customer acceptance provisions are satisfied prior to revenue recognition. There are no further obligations on the part (Continued) 75
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED of the Company subsequent to revenue recognition except for returns of product from the Company's customers. The Company does accept returns of products if properly requested, authorized and approved by the Company. The Company records an estimate of returns of products returned by its customers. Management continuously monitors and tracks such product returns and records the provision for the estimated amount of such future returns, based on historical experience and any notification the Company receives of pending returns. The Electronic segment's selling price to its customers is a fixed amount that is not subject to refund or adjustment or contingent upon additional rebates. The Wireless segment has sales agreements with certain customers that provide for a rebate of the selling price if the particular product is subsequently sold at a lower price. The Wireless segment records an estimate of the rebate at the time of sale. (e) Sales Incentives Both of the Company's segments, Wireless and Electronics, offer sales incentives to its customers in the form of (1) co-operative advertising allowances; (2) market development funds and (3) volume incentive rebates. The Electronics segment also offers other trade allowances to its customers. The terms of the sales incentives vary by customer and are offered from time to time. Except for other trade allowances, all sales incentives require the customer to purchase the Company's products during a specified period of time. All sales incentives require the customer to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period. Although all sales incentives require customers to claim the sales incentive within a certain time period (referred to as the "claim period"), the Wireless segment historically has settled sales incentives claimed after the claim period has expired if a customer demands payment. The sales incentive liabilities are settled either by the customer claiming a deduction against an outstanding account receivable owed to the Company by the customer or by the customer requesting a check from the Company. The Company is unable to demonstrate that an identifiable benefit of the sales incentives has been received as such, all costs associated with sales incentives are classified as a reduction of net sales. The following is a summary of the various sales incentive programs offered by the Company and the related accounting policies: Co-operative advertising allowances are offered to customers as reimbursement towards their costs for print or media advertising in which our product is featured on its own or in conjunction with other companies' products (e.g., a weekly advertising circular by a mass merchant). The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period. Market development funds are offered to customers in connection with new product launches or entering into new markets. Those new markets can be either new geographic areas or new customers. The amount offered for new product launches is based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer during a specified time period. The Company accrues the cost of co-operative advertising (Continued) 76
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED allowances and market development funds at the later of when the customer purchases our products or when the sales incentive is offered to the customer. Volume incentive rebates offered to customers require that minimum quantities of product be purchased during a specified period of time. The amount offered is either based upon a fixed percentage of the Company's sales revenue to the customer or is a fixed amount per unit sold to the customer. Certain of the volume incentive rebates offered to customers include a sliding scale of the amount of the sales incentive with different required minimum quantities to be purchased. The customer's achievement of the sales threshold and, consequently, the measurement of the total rebate for the Wireless segment cannot be reasonably estimated. Accordingly, the Wireless segment recognizes a liability for the maximum potential amount of the rebate, with the exception of certain volume incentive rebates that include very aggressive tiered levels of volume purchases as the underlying revenue transactions that result in progress by the customer toward earning the rebate or refund on a program by program basis are recognized. The Electronics segment makes an estimate of the ultimate amount of the rebate their customers will earn based upon past history with the customer and other facts and circumstances. The Electronics segment has the ability to estimate these volume incentive rebates as there does not exist a relatively long period of time for a particular rebate to be claimed, the Electronics segment does have historical experience with these sales incentive programs and the Electronics segment does have a large volume of relatively homogenous transactions. Any changes in the estimated amount of volume incentive rebates are recognized immediately using a cumulative catch-up adjustment. With respect to the accounting for co-operative advertising allowances, market development funds and volume incentive rebates, there was no impact upon the adoption of EITF 01-9, "Accounting for Consideration Given by a Vendor to a Customer (Including a Reseller of Vendor's Products)", as the Company's accounting policy prior to March 1, 2002 was consistent with its accounting policy after the adoption of EITF 01-9. Other trade allowances are additional sales incentives that the Company provides to the Electronics segment customers subsequent to the related revenue being recognized. In accordance with EITF 01-9, the Company records the provision for these additional sales incentives at the later of when the sales incentive is offered or when the related revenue is recognized. Such additional sales incentives are based upon a fixed percentage of the selling price to the customer, a fixed amount per unit, or a lump-sum amount. For the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities amounted to $9,348, $14,369 and $4,716, respectively. These reversals include unearned sales incentives and unclaimed sales (Continued) 77
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED incentives. Unearned sales incentives are volume incentive rebates where the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified time. Volume incentive rebates for both segments are reversed into income in the period when the customer did not purchase the required minimum quantities of product during the specified time. Unearned sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $4,167, $9,051 and $1,354, respectively. Unclaimed sales incentives are sales incentives earned by the customer but the customer has not claimed payment of the earned sales incentive from the Company. Unclaimed sales incentives for fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 amounted to $5,181, $5,318 and $3,362, respectively. The accrual for earned but unclaimed sales incentives is reversed by Wireless only when management is able to conclude, based upon an individual judgement of each sales incentive, that it is remote that the customer will claim the sales incentive. The methodology applied for determining the amount and timing of reversals for the Wireless segment is disciplined, consistent and rational. The methodology is not systematic (formula based), as the Company makes an estimate as to when it is remote that the sales incentive will not be claimed. Reversals by the Wireless segment of unclaimed sales incentives have historically occurred in varying periods up to 12 months after the recognition of the accrual. In deciding on whether to reverse the sales incentive liability into income, the Company makes an assessment as to the likelihood of the customer ever claiming the funds after the claim period has expired and considers the specific facts and circumstances pertaining to the individual sales incentive. The factors considered by management in making the decision to reverse accruals for unclaimed sales incentives include (i) past practices of the customer requesting payments after the expiration of the claim period; (ii) recent negotiations with the customer for new sales incentives; (iii) subsequent communications with the customer with regard to the status of the claim; and (iv) recent activity in the customer's account. The Electronics segment reverses earned but unclaimed sales incentives upon the expiration of the claim period. The Company believes that the reversal of earned but unclaimed sales incentives for Electronics upon the expiration of the claim period is a disciplined, rational, consistent and systematic method of reversing unclaimed sales incentives. For the Electronics segment, the majority of sales incentive programs are calendar-year programs. Accordingly, the program ends on the month following the fiscal year-end and the claim period expires one year from the end of the program. The accrual for sales incentives at November 30, 2001 and 2002 was $8,474 and $12,151, respectively. The Company's sales incentive liability may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for these arrangements. Therefore, although the Company makes its best estimate of its sales incentive liability, many factors, including significant unanticipated changes (Continued) 78
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED in the purchasing volume of its customers and the lack of claims made by customers of offered and accepted sales incentives, could have significant impact on the Company's liability for sales incentives and the Company's reported operating results. (f) Inventory Inventory consists principally of finished goods and is stated at the lower of the actual cost to purchase (primarily on a weighted moving average basis) and/or the current estimated market value of the inventory less expected costs to sell the inventory. The Company regularly reviews inventory quantities on-hand and records a provision for excess and obsolete inventory based primarily on open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the balance sheet date as well as indications from customers based upon the then current negotiations. As demonstrated in recent years, demand for the Company's products can fluctuate significantly. A significant sudden increase in the demand for the Company's products could result in a short-term increase in the cost of inventory purchases while a significant decrease in demand could result in an increase in the amount of excess inventory quantities on-hand. In addition, the Company's industry is characterized by rapid technological change and frequent new product introductions that could result in an increase in the amount of obsolete inventory quantities on-hand. In such situations, the Company generally does not obtain price protection from its vendors, however, on occasion, the Company has received price protection which reduces the cost of inventory. Since price protection reduces the cost of inventory, as the Company sells the inventory for which it has received price protection, the amount is reflected as a reduction to cost of sales. There can be no assurances that the Company will be successful in negotiating such price protection from its vendors in the future. The Company has, on occasion, performed upgrades on certain inventory on behalf of its vendors. The reimbursements the Company receives to perform these upgrades are reflected as a reduction to the cost of inventory and is recognized as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory is sold. Additionally, the Company's estimates of excess and obsolete inventory may prove to be inaccurate, in which case the Company may have understated or overstated the provision required for excess and obsolete inventory. In the future, if the Company's inventory is determined to be overvalued, it would be required to recognize such costs in its cost of goods sold at the time of such determination. Likewise, if the Company does not properly estimate the lower of cost or market of its inventory and it is therefore determined to be undervalued, it may have over-reported its cost of goods sold in previous periods and would be required to recognize such additional operating income at the time of sale. Therefore, although the Company makes every effort to ensure the accuracy of its forecasts of future product demand, any significant unanticipated changes in demand or technological developments could have a significant impact on the value of the Company's inventory and its reported (Continued) 79
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED operating results. The Company maintains a significant investment in inventory and, therefore, is subject to the risk of losses on write-downs to market and inventory obsolescence. During the fourth quarter of 2000, the Company decided to substantially exit the analog phone line of business to reflect the shift in the wireless industry from analog to digital technology and recorded a charge of approximately $8,152 to reduce its carrying value of its analog inventory to estimated market value. During the second quarter of 2001, the Company recorded an additional charge of approximately $13,500 to further adjust the carrying value of its analog inventory to market. During the fourth quarter of 2001, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs to market of $7,150 as a result of the reduction of selling prices primarily related to digital hand- held phones during the first quarter of 2002 in anticipation of new digital technologies. During the year ended November 30, 2002, Wireless recorded inventory write-downs to market of $13,823. These write-downs were made based upon open purchase orders from customers and selling prices subsequent to the respective balance sheet dates as well as indications from our customers based upon current negotiations. It is reasonably possible that additional write-downs to market may be required in the future given the continued emergence of new technologies, however, no estimate can be made of such write-downs. At November 30, 2002, Wireless had on hand 640,084 units of previously written-down inventory, which approximated $94,264. For certain inventory items, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from the manufacturer. The Company records such price protection, as necessary, at the time of the sale of the units. As of November 30, 2002, such price protection amounted to $32,643, of which $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory was sold. The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost. (g) Investment Securities The Company classifies its equity securities in one of two categories: trading or available- for-sale. Trading securities are bought and held principally for the purpose of selling them in the near term. All other securities not included in trading are classified as available-for-sale. Trading and available-for-sale securities are recorded at fair value. Unrealized holding gains and losses on trading securities are included in earnings. Unrealized holding gains and losses, net of the related tax effect, on available-for-sale securities are excluded from earnings and are reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive (Continued) 80
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED income until realized. Realized gains and losses from the sale of available-for-sale securities are determined on a specific identification basis. A decline in the market value of any available-for-sale security below cost that is deemed other-than-temporary results in a reduction in carrying amount to fair value. The impairment is charged to earnings and a new cost basis for the security is established (such a charge was recorded during fiscal 2002 - Note 9). Dividend and interest income are recognized when earned. The Company considers numerous factors, on a case by case basis, in evaluating whether the decline in market value of an available-for-sale security below cost is other-than-temporary. Such factors include, but are not limited to, (i)the length of time and the extent to which the market value has been less than cost; (ii) the financial condition and the near-term prospects of the issuer of the investment; and (iii) whether the Company's intent to retain the investment for the period of time is sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value. (h) Derivative Financial Instruments Effective December 1, 2000, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" (Statement 133), which establishes new accounting and reporting guidelines for derivative instruments and hedging activities. Statement 133 requires the recognition of all derivative financial instruments as either assets or liabilities in the statements of financial condition and measurement of those instruments at fair value. Changes in the fair values of those derivatives are reported in earnings or other comprehensive income (loss) depending on the designation of the derivative and whether it qualifies for hedge accounting. The accounting for gains and losses associated with changes in the fair value of a derivative and the effect on the consolidated financial statements will depend on its hedge designation and whether the hedge is highly effective in achieving offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of the asset or liability hedged. Under the provisions of Statement 133, the method that will be used for assessing the effectiveness of a hedging derivative, as well as the measurement approach for determining the ineffective aspects of the hedge, must be established at the inception of the hedged instrument. The adoption of Statement 133 had no impact on the Company's results of operations or financial position. The Company's evaluations of hedge effectiveness are subject to assumptions based on the terms and timing of the underlying exposures. For a fair value hedge, both the effective and ineffective portions of the change in fair value of the derivative instrument, along with an adjustment to the carrying amount of the hedge item for fair value changes attributable to the hedge risk, are recognized in earnings. For a cash flow hedge, changes in the fair value of a derivative instrument that is highly effective are deferred in accumulated other comprehensive income or loss until the underlying hedged item (Continued) 81
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED is recognized in earnings. The ineffective portion is recognized in earnings immediately. If a fair value or cash flow hedge was to cease to qualify for hedge accounting or be terminated, it would continue to be carried on the balance sheet at fair value until settled, but hedge accounting would be discontinued prospectively. If a forecasted transaction were no longer probable of occurring, amounts previously deferred in accumulated other comprehensive income would be recognized immediately in earnings. The Company, as a policy, does not use derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. The Company conducts business in several foreign currencies and, as a result, is subject to foreign currency exchange rate risk due to the effects that exchange rate movements of these currencies have on the Company's costs. To minimize the effect of exchange rate fluctuations on costs, the Company enters into forward exchange rate contracts. The Company, as a policy, does not enter into forward exchange contracts for trading purposes. The forward exchange rate contracts are entered into as hedges of inventory purchase commitments and of trade receivables due in foreign currencies. Gains and losses on the forward exchange contracts that qualify as hedges are reported as a component of the underlying transaction. Foreign currency transactions which have not been hedged are marked to market on a current basis with gains and losses recognized through income and reflected in other income (expense). In addition, any previously deferred gains and losses on hedges which are terminated prior to the transaction date are recognized in current income when the hedge is terminated. At November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company had no contracts to exchange foreign currencies in the form of forward exchange contracts. For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, gains and losses on foreign currency transactions which were not hedged were not material. For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, there were no gains or losses as a result of terminating hedges prior to the transaction date. (i) Debt Issuance Costs Costs incurred in connection with the restructuring of bank obligations (Note 15) have been capitalized. During 2000, the Company capitalized an additional $148 in fees associated with the restructuring and various amendments to the Company's credit agreement. These charges are amortized over the lives of the respective agreements. Amortization expense of these costs amounted to $434, $336 and $379 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. (Continued) 82
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (j) Property, Plant and Equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Equipment under capital lease is stated at the present value of minimum lease payments. Depreciation is calculated on the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets as follows: Buildings 20-30 years Furniture, fixtures and displays 5-10 years Machinery and equipment 5-10 years Computer hardware and software 3-5 years Automobiles 3 years Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the lease term or estimated useful life of the asset. Assets acquired under capital lease are amortized over the term of the lease. Capitalized computer software costs obtained for internal use are amortized on a straight- line basis. (k) Intangible Assets Intangible assets consist of patents, trademarks and the excess cost over fair value of equity investments (goodwill). In July 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued SFAS No. 141, "Business Combinations" and SFAS No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets". SFAS No. 141 requires that the purchase method of accounting be used for all future business combinations and specifies criteria intangible assets acquired in a business combination must meet to be recognized and reported apart from goodwill. SFAS No. 142 requires that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives no longer be amortized, but instead be tested for impairment at least annually in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 142. SFAS No. 142 also requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives and reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the impairment of Long-Live Assets to be Disposed Of". The Company early adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and SFAS No. 142 as of December 1, 2001. As a result of adopting the provisions of SFAS No. 141 and 142, the Company did not record amortization expense relating to its goodwill, which approximated $9,616, during the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002. The Company was not required under SFAS No. 142 to assess the useful life and residual value of its goodwill as the Company's goodwill, at the time of adoption, was equity method (Continued) 83
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED goodwill and, as such, will continue to be evaluated for impairment under Accounting Pronouncement Board No. 18, "The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock", as amended. As required by the adoption of SFAS No. 142, the Company reassessed the useful lives and residual values of all acquired intangible assets to make any necessary amortization period adjustments. Based upon that assessment, no adjustments were made to the amortization period of residual values of other intangible assets. The cost of other intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their respective lives. Accumulated amortization on the Company's intangible assets of $8,244 and $10,337 approximated $3,502 and $3,511 as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. As of November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002, the Company had intangible assets subject to amortization of $711 and $711, respectively, and related accumulated amortization of $692 and $711, respectively, which pertained to trademarks and patents. Amortization expense for intangible assets subject to amortization amounted to $15 and $9 for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. As of November 30, 2002, all intangible assets subject to amortization have been fully amortized. Accordingly, the estimated aggregate amortization expense for each of the five succeeding years ending November 30, 2007 amounts to $0. Had SFAS No. 142 been applied retrospectively to the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, there would be no impact to reported net income or loss per share, respectively. As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company had unamortized goodwill in the amount of $4,732 and $6,826, respectively. In accordance with SFAS No. 142, the Company wrote-off its unamortized negative goodwill of $240 as of the date of adoption, which has been reflected in the consolidated statements of operations as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle. During the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, the Company recorded $16 and $16, respectively, for the amortization of negative goodwill. In March 2002, in connection with the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc. by Code Systems, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp., the Company recorded $1,854 of goodwill. (Continued) 84
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The following table presents adjusted net losses and loss per share data restated to include the retroactive impact of the adoption of SFAS No. 142: Years Ended November 30, ------------------------ 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change $ 25,303 $ (7,198) $ (14,280) Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt 2,189 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax - - 240 ---------- ----------- ---------- Reported net income (loss) 27,492 (7,198) (14,040) Add back: Goodwill amortization, net of tax 343 224 - ---------- ----------- ---------- Adjusted net income (loss) $ 27,835 $ (6,974) $ (14,040) ========== =========== ========== Basic net income (loss) per common share: Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change $ 1.19 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax - - 0.01 ---------- ----------- ---------- Net income (loss) 1.29 (0.33) (0.64) Goodwill amortization, net of tax 0.01 0.01 - ---------- ----------- ---------- Adjusted net income (loss) $ 1.30 $ (0.32) $ (0.64) ========== =========== ========== Diluted net income (loss) per common share: Reported net income (loss) before extraordinary item and accounting change $ 1.12 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) Extraordinary item - gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle, net of tax - - 0.01 ---------- ----------- ---------- Net income (loss) 1.22 (0.33) (0.64) Goodwill amortization, net of tax 0.01 0.01 - ---------- ----------- ---------- Adjusted net income (loss) $ 1.23 $ (0.32) $ (0.64) ========== =========== ========== Weighted average common shares outstanding: Basic 21,393,566 21,877,100 21,850,035 ========== =========== ========== Diluted 22,565,806 21,877,100 21,850,035 ========== =========== ========== (Continued) 85
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The change in carrying amount of goodwill is as follows: Year Ended November 30, 2002 ------------ Net balance as of November 30, 2001 $4,732 Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 240 Goodwill acquired during the period 1,854 ------ Net Balance as of November 30, 2002 $6,826 ====== (l) Equity Investments The Company has common stock investments which are accounted for by the equity method as the Company owns between 20% and 50% of the common stock. The Company applies the equity method of accounting to its investments in entities where the Company has non-controlling ownership interests. The Company's share of its equity method investees earnings or losses is included in the consolidated statements of operations. The Company eliminates its pro rata share of gross profit on sales to its equity method investees for inventory on hand at the investees at the end of the year. A description of the Company's equity investments and the related transactions between the Company and these investees is discussed in Note 11. (m) Cellular Telephone Commissions Under various agency agreements, the Company receives an initial activation commission for obtaining subscribers for cellular telephone services. The agreements may contain provisions for additional commissions based upon usage and length of continued subscription. The agreements also provide for the reduction or elimination of initial activation commissions if subscribers deactivate service within stipulated periods. The Company has provided a liability for estimated cellular deactivations which is reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements as a reduction of accounts receivable. The Company recognizes sales revenue for the initial activation and residual commissions based upon usage on the accrual basis. Such commissions approximated $32,475, $29,859 and $26,756 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Related commissions paid to outside selling representatives for cellular activations are included in cost of sales in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations and amounted to $23,186, $22,390 and $18,673 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. (Continued) 86
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (n) Advertising The Company expenses the costs of advertising as incurred, excluding co-operative advertising (see sales incentives Note 1(e). During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had no direct response advertising. (o) Product Warranties and Product Repair Costs The Company generally warrants its products against certain manufacturing and other defects. The Company provides warranties for all of its products ranging from 90 days to the lifetime of the product. Warranty expenses are accrued at the time of sale based on the Company's estimated cost to repair expected returns for products. This liability is based primarily on historical experiences of actual warranty claims as well as current information on repair costs. The warranty liability of $9,165 and $9,143 is recorded in accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. In addition, the Company records a reserve for product repair costs. This reserve is based upon the quantities of defective inventory on hand and an estimate of the cost to repair such defective inventory. The reserve for product repair costs of $3,902 and $6,267 is recorded as a reduction to inventory in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Warranty claims and product repair costs expense for each of the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $8,256, $11,319 and $6,985, respectively. The following table provides the changes in the Company's product warranties and product repair costs for 2002: December 1, 2001 $ 13,066 Liabilities accrued for warranties issued during the period 6,985 Warranty claims paid during the period (4,641) -------- November 30, 2002 $ 15,410 ======== (p) Foreign Currency With the exception of a subsidiary operation in Venezuela, which was deemed a hyper inflationary economy in fiscal 2000 and 2001, assets and liabilities of those subsidiaries and equity investees located outside the United States whose cash flows are primarily in local currencies have been translated at rates of exchange at the end of the period or historical exchange rates, as appropriate. Revenues and expenses have been translated at the weighted average rates of exchange in effect during the period. Gains and losses resulting from translation are accumulated in the cumulative foreign currency translation account in accumulated other comprehensive income. For the operation in Venezuela, (Continued) 87
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED financial statements are translated at either current or historical exchange rates, as appropriate. These adjustments, along with gains and losses on currency transactions, are reflected in the consolidated statements of operations for fiscal 2000 and 2001. During the first quarter of fiscal 2002 (January 1, 2002), Venezuela ceased to be deemed a hyper- inflationary economy (see Note 2). Exchange gains and losses on intercompany balances of a long-term nature are also recorded in the cumulative foreign currency translation adjustment account in accumulated other comprehensive loss. Exchange gains and losses on available-for-sale investment securities are recorded in the unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities in accumulated other comprehensive loss. Other foreign currency transaction gains of $193, $200 and $418 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, were included in other income. (q) Income Taxes Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled (Note 16). The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. (r) Net Income (Loss) Per Common Share Basic earnings (loss) per common share is based upon the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings (loss) per common share reflects the potential dilution that would occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock were exercised or converted into common stock. Dilutive net loss per common share for fiscal 2001 and 2002 is the same as basic net loss per common share due to the anti-dilutive effect of the exercise of stock options. (s) Supplementary Financial Statement Information Interest income of approximately $1,616, $670 and $509 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 respectively, is included in other, net, in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. (Continued) 88
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (t) Use of Estimates The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, including the allowance for doubtful accounts, allowance for cellular deactivations, inventory valuation, recoverability of deferred tax assets, valuation of long-lived assets and accrued sales incentives, warranty reserves and disclosure of the contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. (u) Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of The Company accounts for its long-lived assets in accordance with the provisions of SFAS No.121. Statement 121 requires that long-lived assets and certain identifiable intangibles be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by comparison of the carrying amount of an asset to the future net cash flows expected to be generated by the asset. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceed the fair value of assets. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. In October 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 144, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets" (Statement 144), which addresses financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets. This statement supersedes Statement 121 while retaining the fundamental recognition and measurement provisions of that statement. Statement 144 requires that a long-lived asset to be abandoned, exchanged for a similar productive asset or distributed to owners in a spin-off to be considered held and used until it is disposed of. However, Statement 144 requires that management consider revising the depreciable life of such long-lived asset. With respect to long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale, Statement 144 retains the provisions of Statement 121 and, therefore, requires that discontinued operations no longer be measured on a net realizable value basis and that future operating losses associated with such discontinued operations no longer be recognized before they occur. Statement 144 is effective for all fiscal quarters of fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2001, and will thus be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2002 (fiscal 2003). The adoption of Statement 144 did not have any impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements. (Continued) 89
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (v) Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation As allowed by SFAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation", the Company applies the intrinsic value-based method of accounting prescribed by Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees", and related interpretations, in accounting for its stock-based compensation plans (APB No. 25). (w) Reporting Comprehensive Income Effective December 1, 1998, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income" (Statement 130). Statement 130 requires that all items recognized under accounting standards as components of comprehensive income be reported in an annual financial statement that is displayed with the same prominence as other annual financial statements. Other comprehensive income may include foreign currency translation adjustments, minimum pension liability adjustments and unrealized gains and losses on investment securities classified as available- for-sale and fair market value changes for cash flow hedges. (x) New Accounting Pronouncements In July 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, "Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations" (Statement 143). Statement 143 is effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2002, and this will be adopted by the Company on December 1, 2003 (fiscal 2004) and establishes an accounting standard requiring the recording of the fair value of liabilities associated with the retirement of long-lived assets in the period in which they are incurred. The Company does not expect the adoption of Statement 143 to have a significant effect on its results of operations or its financial position. SFAS 145 "Rescission of SFAS Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of SFAS No. 13 and Technical Corrections". This Statement updates, clarifies and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements by rescinding Statement 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of related income tax effect. As a result, the criteria in Opinion 30 will now be used to classify those gains and losses. This statement will have no material effect on the Company's financial statements. In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation - Transition and Disclosure". SFAS No. 148 provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation as originally provided by SFAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock- Based Compensation". Additionally, SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 123 to require prominent disclosure in both annual and interim financial (Continued) 90
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED statements about the method of accounting for stock-based compensation and the effect of the method used on reported results. The transitional requirements of SFAS No. 148 will be effective for all financial statements for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002. The disclosure requirements shall be effective for financial reports containing condensed financial statements for interim periods beginning after December 31, 2002. The Company expects to adopt the disclosure portion of this statement for the fiscal quarter ending February 28, 2003. The application of this standard will have no impact on the Company's consolidated financial position or results of operations. In February 2003, the EITF Issued 02-16, "Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor". This EITF provides guidance on the income statement classification of amounts received by a customer, including a reseller and guidance regarding timing of recognition for volume rebates. The Company does not believe that adoption of this new standard, which will be applied prospectively by the Company for new arrangements, including modifications of existing arrangements, entered into after December 31, 2002, will have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial position or results of operations. In November 2002, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 45 (FIN 45), "Guarantor's Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantors, Including Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others". FIN 45 elaborates on the disclosures to be made by a guarantor in its interim and annual financial statements about its obligations under certain guarantees that it has issued. It also clarifies that a guarantor is required to recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee. The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of FIN 45 are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002, irrespective of the guarantor's fiscal year-end. The disclosure requirements of FIN 45 are effective for financial statements of interim or annual periods ending after December 15, 2002. The Company does not expect the adoption of FIN 45 to have a material effect on its consolidated financial position or results of operations. In January 2003, the FASB issued Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), "Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, an interpretation of ARB No. 51". FIN 46 addresses the consolidation by business enterprises of variable interest entities as defined in the Interpretation. FIN 46 is effective for all new variable interest entities created or acquired after January 31, 2003. For variable interest entities created or acquired prior to February 1, 2003, the provisions of FIN 46 must be applied for the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. The adoption of FIN 46 is being evaluated to determine what impact, if any, the adoption of the provisions will have on the Company's financial condition or results of operations. (Continued) 91
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (y) Shipping and Handling Costs In fiscal 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF Issue No. 00-10, "Accounting for Shipping and Handling Fees and Costs", which requires the Company to report all amounts billed to a customer related to shipping and handling as revenue. The Company includes all costs incurred for shipping and handling as cost of sales. The Company has reclassified such billed amounts, which were previously netted in cost of sales to net sales. As a result of this reclassification, net sales and cost of goods sold were increased by $2,162 and $1,548 for years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, respectively. (z) Issuances of Subsidiary Stock The Company's accounting policy on the issuances of subsidiary stock is to recognize through earnings the gain on the sale of the shares as long as the sale of the shares is not part of a broader corporate reorganization planned or contemplated by the Company and realization of the gain is assured. (aa) Reclassifications Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2000 and 2001 consolidated financial statements in order to conform to the 2002 presentation. (2) Restatement of Consolidated Financial Statements The Company has restated its consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 and for the quarters ended February 28, 2002, May 31, 2002 and August 31, 2002. In addition, the Company has reclassified certain expenses from operating expenses to cost of sales for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for each of the quarters in the nine months ended August 31, 2002. These restatement adjustments are the result of the misapplication of generally accepted accounting principles. (Continued) 92
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The net effect of all of the restatement adjustments is as follows: First Second Third Fiscal Fiscal Quarter Quarter Quarter 2000 2001 2002 2002 2002 ------ ------ ------ ------ ----- (Unaudited) (Unaudited) (Unaudited) Increase (decrease) income/(increase) decrease (loss) before extraordinary item and cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ 263 $1,011 $(1,308) $ (782) $ 751 Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) 263 1,011 (1,308) (782) 751 Increase (decrease) net income/ (increase) decrease net (loss) per common share - diluted $0.01 $ 0.05 $ (0.06) $(0.03) $ 0.04 The following table provides additional information regarding these restatement adjustments: EFFECTS OF RESTATEMENT ADJUSTMENTS ON NET INCOME OR NET LOSS (IN THOUSANDS) INCREASE (DECREASE) (INCREASE) DECREASE INCREASE (DECREASE) IN NET INCOME FOR THE IN NET LOSS FOR THE IN NET INCOME FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED FISCAL YEAR ENDED NINE MONTHS ENDED NOVEMBER 30, 2000 NOVEMBER 30, 2001 AUGUST 31, 2002 ----------------- ----------------- ---------------- Unaudited Restatement adjustments: - ------------------------ Revenue recognition $ (779) $ 779 - Timing of revenue (15) $ (103) Litigation (373) 427 Foreign currency translation - - (1,491) Inventory pricing - - 420 Sales incentives 1,884 910 847 Gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares - - (1,556) Operating expense reclassification to cost of sales (2) - - - ----------- --------- -------- Total adjustment to pre-tax income (loss) 1,105 1,301 (1,456) (Provision for) recovery of income taxes (842) (310) 204 Minority interest (1) - 20 (87) ----------- --------- -------- Total effect on net income (loss) $ 263 $ 1,011 $ (1,339) =========== ========= ======== (1) This adjustment reflects the impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. (2) This adjustment represents a reclassification of warehousing and technical support and general (Continued) 93
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED and administrative costs (which are components of operating expenses) to cost of sales. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or (loss) for any fiscal year or period presented herein. See Note 26 "Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated" for restatement adjustments to previously reported unaudited quarterly consolidated statements of operations data for the quarters ended February 28, 2001 through August 31, 2002 as a result of the restatements and reclassifications. The following discussion addresses each of the restatement adjustments and the reclassification adjustment for the corrections of accounting errors. Any references to quarterly amounts are unaudited. (a) Revenue recognition. The Company overstated net sales in each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2000 for shipments of product that did not conform to the technical requirements of the customer (i.e., the goods were non-conforming). The Company did not properly evaluate this shipment of non-conforming goods as required in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101 (SAB No. 101), "Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements", which would preclude revenue recognition until the specific performance obligations have been met by the Company. These product shipments resulted in the Company overstating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2000. During the first quarter of fiscal 2001, the Company recorded a sales return of this fiscal 2000 non-conforming product sale. The recording of this product return (sales reversal) resulted in the Company understating net sales by $19,166 and gross profit by $779 for fiscal 2001. (b) Timing of revenue. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company (overstated) understated net sales by $(976), $857, $(4,601), $(7,757) and $10,472, respectively, as the timing of revenue recognition was not in accordance with the established shipping terms with certain customers. SAB 101 specifically states that delivery generally is not considered to have occurred unless the customer has taken title (which is in this situation when the product was delivered to the customer's site). Accordingly, the Company should have deferred revenue recognition until delivery was made to the customer's site. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, gross profit was overstated (understated) by $34, ($19), $99, $562 and ($535), respectively. During each of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, operating expenses were overstated (understated) by $0, $0, $17, $136 and ($130), respectively. (c) Litigation. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2001 and each of the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overestimated its provisions for certain litigation matters, (Continued) 94
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED thereby overstating cost of sales by $314, $176, $345 and $457 for each respective quarterly period. Also, the Company understated operating expenses by $497 in the first quarter of fiscal 2002 as a result of not recording a settlement offer in the period the Company offered it. During the second, third and fourth quarters of 2001 and the first, second and third quarters of 2002, the Company understated (overstated) operating expenses by $189, $302, $196, $78 and $276 and ($300), respectively as a result of inappropriately deferring costs related to an insurance claim. The Company's insurance company refused to defend the Company against a legal claim made against the Company. The Company took legal action against the insurance company and was unsuccessful. The Company was improperly capitalizing costs that were not probable of recovery. (d) Foreign currency translation. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company did not properly account for a change in accounting for its Venezuelan subsidiary as operating in a non-highly inflationary economy. In fiscal 2001 and in prior years, Venezuela was deemed to be a highly-inflationary economy in accordance with certain technical accounting pronouncements. Effective January 1, 2002, it was deemed that Venezuela should cease to be considered a highly-inflationary economy, however, the Company did not account for this change. The Company incorrectly recorded the foreign currency translation adjustment in other income rather than as other comprehensive income. As a result, the Company understated other expenses, net, by $1,360 for the first quarter of fiscal 2002, overstated other income, net, by $71 for the second quarter of fiscal 2002 and understated other expenses, net, by $243 for the third quarter of fiscal 2002. Also the Company overstated operating expenses by $41, $54 and $88 for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. (e) Inventory pricing. During the first three quarters of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales related to an inventory pricing error that occurred at its Venezuelan subsidiary. The Company was not aware of this pricing error until the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002 and, accordingly, was not properly pricing its inventory at the lower of cost or market in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. As a result, the Company overstated (understated) cost of sales by $387, ($2) and $35, for the first, second and third quarters of fiscal 2002, respectively. (f) Sales incentives. During fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Electronics segment overestimated accruals for additional sales incentives (other trade allowances) that were not yet offered to its customers. As a result, for fiscal 2000 and 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $1,884, $784 and $292, respectively. Furthermore, during fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002,the (Continued) 95
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Electronics segment was also not reversing earned and unclaimed sales incentives (i.e., cooperative advertising, market development and volume incentive rebate funds) upon the expiration of the established claim period. As a result, for fiscal 2001 and for the nine months ended August 31, 2002, the Company understated net sales by $126 and $555, respectively. (g) Gain on the Issuance of Subsidiary Shares. During the second quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company overstated the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares by $1,735 due to expenses related to this issuance being charged to additional paid in capital. This adjustment also reflects the impact of the other restatement adjustments on the calculation of the gain on the issuance of subsidiary shares of $179 that was originally recorded by the Company in the quarter ended May 31, 2002. As a result, the Company decreased the gain on issuance of subsidiary shares and increased the additional paid in capital by $1,556. (h) Income taxes. Income taxes were adjusted for the restatement adjustments discussed above for each period presented. The Company also applied income taxes to minority interest amounts during all quarters of fiscal 2000 and 2001, as well as the first three quarters of fiscal 2002. As a result of all these adjustments, the Company overstated (understated) the provision for/recovery of income taxes by $(842), ($310) and $(455) for fiscal 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. (i) Operating expense reclassification. The Company reclassified certain costs as operating expenses, which were included as a component of warehousing and technical support and general and administrative costs, which should have been classified as a component of cost of sales. The effect of this reclassification on fiscal 2000 and 2001 was to increase cost of sales and decrease operating expenses by $17,962 and $20,024, respectively. The effect of this reclassification for the nine months ended August 31, 2002 was to understate cost of sales and overstate operating expenses by $15,488. This reclassification did not have any effect on previously reported net income or loss for any fiscal year or period presented herein. This reclassification reduced gross margin by 1.0, 1.6 and 1.9 percentage points for fiscal years November 30, 2000, 2001 and the nine months ended August 31, 2002, respectively. (Continued) 96
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The following represents the effect of the restatement and reclassification adjustments in the fiscal 2000 and 2001 consolidated statements of operations and consolidated balance sheet: CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE AND PER SHARE DATA) NOVEMBER 30, 2000 -------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED(1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ------------ ----------- Net sales $1,687,573 $ (17,282)(2)(5) - $1,670,291 Cost of sales 1,552,091 (18,387)(2) $ 17,962(3) 1,551,666 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Gross profit 135,482 1,105 (17,962) 118,625 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Operating expenses: Selling 29,056 - - 29,056 General and administrative 49,800 - (3,334)(3) 46,466 Warehousing and technical support 18,102 - (14,628)(3) 3,474 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Total operating expenses 96,958 - (17,962) 78,996 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Operating income (loss) 38,524 1,105 - 39,629 Total other income (expense), net 2,514 - - 2,514 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes minority interest and extraordinary item 41,038 1,105 - 42,143 Provision for (recovery of) income taxes 14,924 842(4) - 15,766 Minority interest (1,074) - - (1,074) ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------- Income (loss) before extraordinary item 25,040 263 - 25,303 ---------- ---------- Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 2,189 - - 2,189 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) $ 27,229 $ 263 - $ 27,492 ========== ========== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (basic) before extraordinary item $ 1.17 $ 0.02 - $ 1.19 Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - 0.10 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ 1.27 $ 0.02 - $ 1.29 ========== ========== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) before extraordinary item $ 1.11 $ 0.01 - $ 1.12 Extraordinary item-gain on extinguishment of debt 0.10 - - 0.10 ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ 1.21 $ 0.01 - $ 1.22 ========== ========== ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,393,566 21,393,566 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 22,565,806 22,565,806 ========== ========== (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (Continued) 97
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amounts restated to reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE AND PER SHARE DATA) NOVEMBER 30, 2001 -------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED(1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- Net sales $1,256,634 $ 19,957(2)(6) - $1,276,591 Cost of sales 1,167,208 17,969(2)(4) $ 20,024(3) 1,205,201 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Gross profit 89,426 1,988 (20,024) 71,390 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Operating expenses: Selling 30,039 - - 30,039 General and administrative 46,405 687(4) (587)(3) 46,505 Warehousing and technical support 23,519 - (19,437)(3) 4,082 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Total operating expenses 99,963 687 (20,024) 80,626 ----------- -------- ---------- ---------- Operating income (loss) (10,537) 1,301 - (9,236) Total other income (expense), net (2,246) - (2,246) ---------- ---------- ---------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest (12,783) 1,301 - (11,482) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes (3,937) 310(5) - (3,627) Minority interest 637 20(7) - 657 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) $ (8,209) $ 1,011 - $ (7,198) ========== ======== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ (0.38) $ 0.05 - $ (0.33) ========== ======== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ (0.38) $ 0.05 - $ (0.33) ========== ======== ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,877,100 21,877,100 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,877,100 21,877,100 ========== ========== (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition and (b) timing of revenue . (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amount reflect adjustments for (c) litigation. (5) Amount restated to reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (6) Amount reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (7) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. (Continued) 98
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) NOVEMBER 30, 2001 --------------------------- RESTATEMENT AS REPORTED ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ----------- ASSETS Current assets: Cash $ 3,025 - $ 3,025 Accounts receivable, net 238,476** $ (119) 238,357 Inventory, net 225,662 97 225,759 Receivable from vendor 6,919 (91) 6,828 Prepaid expenses and other current assets 7,632 7 7,639 Deferred income taxes, net 11,997 (32) 11,965 ---------- -------- -------- Total current assets 493,711 (138) 493,573 Investment securities 5,777 - 5,777 Equity investments 10,268 - 10,268 Property, plant and equipment, net 25,687 - 25,687 Excess cost over fair value of assets acquired and other intangible assets, net 4,742 - 4,742 Deferred income taxes, net 3,148 - 3,148 Other assets 1,302 - 1,302 ---------- -------- -------- Total assets $ 544,635 $ (138) $544,497 ========== ======== ======== LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY Current liabilities: Accounts payable $ 57,162 - $ 57,162 Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 41,854 $ 283 42,137 Accrued sales incentives 11,267 (2,793) 8,474 Income taxes payable 3,035 1,119 4,154 Bank obligations 92,213 - 92,213 Notes payable 5,267 - 5,267 ---------- -------- -------- Total current liabilities 210,798 (1,391) 209,407 Long-term debt - - - Capital lease obligation 6,196 - 6,196 Deferred income taxes payable - - - Deferred compensation 3,844 - 3,844 ---------- -------- -------- Total liabilities 220,838 (1,391) 219,447 ---------- -------- -------- Minority interest 1,851 (21) 1,830 ---------- -------- -------- Stockholders' equity: Preferred stock, liquidation preference of $2,500 2,500 - 2,500 Common stock: Class A 207 - 207 Class B 22 - 22 Paid-in capital 250,785 - 250,785 Retained earnings 82,162 1,274 83,436 Accumulated other comprehensive loss (6,344) - (6,344) Treasury stock, at cost, 909,537 and 1,072,737 Class A common stock 2001 and 2002, respectively (7,386) - (7,386) ---------- -------- -------- Total stockholders' equity 321,946 1,274 323,220 ---------- -------- -------- Commitments and contingencies Total liabilities and stockholders' equity $ 544,635 $ (138) $544,497 ========== ======== ======== ** The Company reclassified $11,267 of sales incentives from accounts receivable to accrued sales incentives. (Continued) 99
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED As a result of the restatement for fiscal 2000 and 2001, there has not been any changes to the Company's cash flows from operations, investing activities, or financing activities from previously reported amounts. (3) Issuance of Subsidiary Shares On May 29, 2002, Toshiba Corporation (Toshiba) purchased an additional 20% of ACC, approximately 31 shares at approximately $774 per share, for approximately $23,900 in cash, bringing Toshiba's total ownership interest in Audiovox Communications Corp. (ACC) to 25%. In addition, Toshiba paid $8,100 in exchange for an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note). The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1 3/4% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003. The unpaid principal amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years. In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a 25% interest in ACC, but under no circumstances can Toshiba convert the Note to exceed a 25% interest in ACC. In connection with the transaction, the Company, ACC and Toshiba entered into a stockholders agreement. The stockholders agreement provides for the composition of the board of directors of ACC and identifies certain items, other than in the ordinary course of business, that ACC cannot do without prior approval from Toshiba. The agreement does not require or preclude ACC from paying dividends on a pro-rata basis. The agreement may be terminated upon the mutual written agreement of the parties, if the distribution agreement is terminated or if either party commences a bankruptcy or similar proceeding. The Company has historically been the exclusive distributor for Toshiba in the United States and Canada. In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba formalized this distribution arrangement whereby ACC is Toshiba's exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007. The distribution agreement provides for 30-day payment terms. The distribution agreement established certain annual minimum purchase targets for ACC's purchase of Toshiba products for each fiscal year during the entire term of the agreement. In the event that ACC fails to meet the minimum purchase target, Toshiba shall have the right to convert ACC's exclusive distributorship to a non-exclusive distributorship for the remaining term of the agreement. Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement, Toshiba maintains a put right and the Company a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated in accordance with the agreement. Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company. The call right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial (Continued) 100
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED five (5) year term. Additionally, ACC entered into an employment agreement with the President and Chief Executive Officer (the Executive) of ACC through May 29, 2007. Under the agreement, ACC is required to pay the Executive an annual base salary of $500 in addition to an annual bonus equal to 2% of ACC's annual earnings before income taxes. The Company, under the employment agreement, was required to establish and pay a bonus of $3,200 to key employees of ACC, including the Executive, to be allocated by the Executive. The bonus was for services previously rendered and, accordingly, the bonus has been included in general and administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002. The Executive was required to utilize all or a portion of the bonus allocated to him to repay the remaining outstanding principal and accrued interest owed by the Executive to the Company pursuant to the unsecured promissory note in favor of the Company. During the year ended November 30, 2002, the Executive was paid $1,800 less an amount outstanding under a promissory note of $651. As a result of the issuance of ACC's shares, the Company recognized a gain, net of expenses of $1,735, of $14,269 ($8,847 after provision for deferred taxes) during the quarter ended May 31, 2002. The gain represents the excess of the sale price per share over the carrying amount per share multiplied by the number of shares issued to Toshiba. The gain on the issuance of the subsidiary's shares has been recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002 in accordance with the Company's policy on the recognition of such transactions, which is an allowable method under Staff Accounting Bulleting Topic 5.H. Toshiba's minority interest income (expense) in ACC included in the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 was ($1,094), $501 and $4,741 , respectively. Minority interest is included in the pre-tax income (loss) in the segment data. (4) Supplemental Cash Flow Information The following is supplemental information relating to the consolidated statements of cash flows: For the Years Ended November 30, -------------------------------- 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- Cash paid during the years for: Interest, excluding bank charges $ 4,870 $ 3,883 $ 1,303 Income taxes $21,069 $ 3,550 $ 2,478 Non-cash Transactions: During 2000, the Company exercised its option to convert 800,000 Japanese yen (approximately (Continued) 101
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED $7,595) of Shintom Co. Ltd. (Shintom) convertible debentures (Shintom debentures) into approximately 33,900,000 shares of Shintom common stock, respectively (Note 9). During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company recorded an unrealized holding gain (loss) relating to available-for-sale marketable equity securities, net of deferred income taxes, of $(10,119), $(831) and $422, respectively, as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (Note 19). During 2000, $535 of its $65,000 6 1/4% subordinated debentures were converted into 30,170 shares of Class A common stock (Note 15). During 2001, 314,800 warrants were exercised and converted into 314,800 shares of common stock (Note 18(d)). (5) Transactions With Major Suppliers (a) ACC Dividend In February 2001, the board of directors of ACC declared a dividend payable to its shareholders, Audiovox Corporation, a then 95% shareholder, and Toshiba, a then 5% shareholder for their respective share of net income for the previous fiscal years. ACC paid Toshiba its share of the dividend, which approximated $1,034 in the first quarter of 2001. There were no dividends declared during fiscal 2002. (b) Sale/Leaseback Transaction In April 2000, AX Japan purchased land and a building (the Property) from Shintom Co., Ltd. (Shintom) for 770,000,000 Yen (approximately $7,300) and entered into a leaseback agreement whereby Shintom leased the Property from AX Japan for a one-year period. This lease is being accounted for as an operating lease by AX Japan. Shintom is a stockholder who owns all of the outstanding preferred stock of the Company and is a manufacturer of products purchased by the Company through its previously-owned equity investee, TALK Corporation (TALK). The Company currently holds stock in Shintom and has previously invested in Shintom convertible debentures (Note 9). The purchase of the Property by AX Japan was financed with a 500,000,000 Yen ($4,671) subordinated loan obtained from Vitec Co., Ltd. (Vitec), a 150,000,000 Yen loan ($1,397) from Pearl First (Pearl) and a 140,000,000 Yen loan ($1,291) from the Company. The land and building have been included in property, plant and equipment, and the loans have been recorded as notes payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 . Changes arising from the fluctuations in the Yen exchange rate have been reflected as a component of accumulated other comprehensive loss on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Vitec is a major supplier to Shintom, (Continued) 102
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED and Pearl is an affiliate of Vitec. The loans bear interest at 5% per annum, and principle is payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning six months subsequent to the date of the loans. The loans from Vitec and Pearl are subordinated completely to the loan from the Company and, in liquidation, the Company receives payment first. Upon the expiration of six months after the transfer of the title to the Property to AX Japan, Shintom had the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan. This option could be extended for one additional six month period. The option to repurchase the building is at a price of 770,000,000 Yen plus the equity capital of AX Japan (which in no event can be less than 60,000,000 Yen) and can only be made if Shintom settles any rent due AX Japan pursuant to the lease agreement. The option to purchase the shares of stock of AX Japan is at a price not less than the aggregate par value of the shares and, subsequent to the purchase of the shares, AX Japan must repay the outstanding loan due to the Company. If Shintom does not exercise its option to repurchase the Property or the shares of AX Japan, or upon occurrence of certain events, AX Japan can dispose of the Property as it deems appropriate. The events which result in the ability of AX Japan to be able to dispose of the Property include Shintom petitioning for bankruptcy, failing to honor a check, failing to pay rent, etc. If Shintom fails, or at any time becomes financially or otherwise unable to exercise its option to repurchase the Property, Vitec has the option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan under similar terms as the Shintom options. AX Japan had the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its options to repurchase the Property or stock of AX Japan. In September 2000, Shintom extended its option to repurchase the Property and AX Japan delayed its repayment of the loans for an additional six months. In March 2001, upon the expiration of the additional six-month period, the Company and Shintom agreed to extend the lease for an additional one-year period. In addition, Shintom was again given the option to purchase the Property or shares of stock of AX Japan after the expiration of a six-month period or extend the option for one additional six-month period. AX Japan was also given the option to delay the repayment of the loans for an additional six months if Shintom extended its option for an additional six months. In October 2002, the Company sold all of its shares in AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., an unrelated party to the Company. The purchase price of the shares was 60,000 Yen. As a result of this transaction, the purchaser repaid in full 113,563 Yen which represented the full balance of amounts then owed to the Company by AX Japan. The agreement required the purchaser to immediately change the name of AX Japan to RMS Co., Ltd., and the Company resigned from all officer and board of directors positions. The (Continued) 103
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Company has no further relationship or obligations, whether contingent or direct to RMS Co., Ltd., formerly known as AX Japan. As a result of the completion of this transaction, all assets and liabilities of Audiovox Japan have been removed from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002, specifically the land and the building and the notes payable for the Vitec Co., Ltd (Vitec) 150,000 Yen loan and the Pearl First (Pearl) a 140,000 Yen loan. As a result of this transaction, the Company recovered in Yen its initial investment in AX Japan as well as its loan to finance the purchase of the land and building. However, the Company recognized a $338 loss on the sale of its shares in AX Japan, as the sales price was less than the value of the net assets of AX Japan sold to Vitec. Contributing to the loss on sale were foreign currency loss and other expenses that will not be recovered. The loss on the sale of the shares of AX Japan has been included in other net on the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended November 30, 2002. In connection with the April 2000 transaction, the Company received 100,000,000 Yen ($922) from Shintom for its 2,000 shares of TALK stock. The Company had the option to repurchase the shares of TALK at a purchase price of 50,000 Yen per share, with no expiration date. Given the option to repurchase the shares of TALK, the Company did not surrender control over the shares of TALK and, accordingly, had not accounted for this transaction as a sale. In August 2000, the Company surrendered its option to repurchase the shares of TALK. As such, the Company recorded a gain on the sale of shares in the amount of $427 in August 2000. (c) Inventory Purchases - Shintom and TALK The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK. TALK, which holds world-wide distribution rights for product manufactured by Shintom, has given the Company exclusive distribution rights on all wireless personal communication products for all countries except Japan, China, Thailand and several mid-eastern countries. Through October 2000, the Company held a 30.8% interest in TALK. The Company no longer holds an equity interest in TALK. Transactions with Shintom and TALK include financing arrangements and inventory purchases which approximated 7%, 1.5% and 0.7% for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively, of total inventory purchases. At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded $1, $331 and $13, respectively, of liability due to TALK for inventory purchases included in accounts payable. There were no documentary acceptance obligations payable to TALK as of November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. At November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, the Company had recorded a receivable from TALK in the amount of $3,823, $265 and $0, respectively, a portion of which is payable with interest (Note 8), which is reflected in receivable from vendors (Continued) 104
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED on the accompanying consolidated financial statements. (d) Inventory Purchases - Other Inventory purchases from two major suppliers approximated 72%, 75% and 67% of total inventory purchases for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Although there are a limited number of manufacturers of its products, management believes that other suppliers could provide similar products on comparable terms. A change in suppliers, however, could cause a delay in product availability and a possible loss of sales, which would affect operating results adversely. (6) Business Acquisition On March 15, 2002, Code Systems, Inc. (Code), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp., purchased certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc., an automotive security product company. The results of operations of Code-Alarm, Inc. are included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements from the date of purchase. The purchase price consisted of approximately $7,100, paid in cash at the closing, and a debenture (CSI Debenture) whose value is linked to the future earnings of Code, however, in accordance with the terms of the agreement, the CSI debenture has an initial estimated value of $40,000. The payment of any amount under the terms of the CSI Debenture is based on performance and is scheduled to occur in the first calendar quarter of 2006. The Company accounted for the transaction in accordance with the purchase method of accounting. As a result of the transaction, goodwill of $1,854 was recorded. The allocation of the purchase price is pending the final determination of certain acquired balances. Any payments made under the terms of the CSI Debenture in the future will be reflected as a component of goodwill. Proforma results of operations were not provided as the amounts were deemed immaterial to the consolidated financial statements of the Company. Simultaneous with this business acquisition, the Company entered into a purchase and supply agreement with a third party. Under the terms of this agreement, the third party will purchase or direct its suppliers to purchase certain products from the Company. In exchange for entering into this agreement, the Company issued 50 warrants in its subsidiary, Code, which vest immediately. These warrants were deemed to have minimal value based upon the current value of Code. Furthermore, the agreement calls for the issuance of additional warrants based upon the future operating performance of Code. Based upon the contingent nature of these warrants, no recognition was given to these contingent warrants in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. (Continued) 105
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (7) Accounts Receivable Accounts receivable is comprised of the following: November 30, ------------------------- 2001 2002 ---- ---- As Restated ----------- Trade accounts receivable and other $245,289 $195,228 Less: Allowance for doubtful accounts 4,715 6,829 Allowance for cellular deactivations 2,035 1,628 Allowance for cash discounts 182 207 -------- -------- $238,357 $186,564 ======== ======== (8) Receivable from Vendor The Company recorded receivable from vendor in the amount of $6,828 and $14,174 as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Receivable from vendor represents prepayments on product shipments, defective product reimbursements and interest receivable at a rate of 4.03% at November 30, 2001, on amounts due from TALK (Note 5) and $4,550 at November 30, 2001 for reimbursements for costs incurred by the Company for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured. At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades. Subsequent to November 30, 2002 the receivables from Toshiba were paid in full. (9) Investment Securities As of November 30, 2001, the Company's investment securities consist of $1,933 of available-for- sales marketable securities, which consist primarily of 1,530,000 shares of CellStar Common Stock and 1,904,000 shares of Shintom common stock and trading securities of $3,844, which consist of mutual funds that are held in connection with the deferred compensation plan. As of November 30, 2002, the Company's investment securities consist of $1,455 of available-for- sales marketable securities, which relates to 306,000 shares (after a 5 for 1 reverse stock split) of CellStar Common Stock, 1,904,000 shares of Shintom Common Stock and trading securities of $3,949 which consist of mutual funds that are held in connection with the deferred compensation plan. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded a $1,158 other-than-temporary impairment of its Shintom common stock. (Continued) 106
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The cost, gross unrealized gains and losses and aggregate fair value of the investment securities available-for-sale as of November 30, 2001 and 2002 were as follows: 2001 2002 ---------------------------------------- -------------------------------------------------------- Gross Gross Other-than- Unrealized Aggregate Unrealized Temporary Aggregate Holding Fair Holding Impairment Fair Cost Gain (Loss) Value Cost Gain (Loss) Charge Value ---- ----------- ------- ---- ----------- ------- ------ CellStar Common Stock $ 2,401 $ (1,055) $ 1,346 $ 2,401 $ (966) - $ 1,435 Shintom Common Stock 1,179 (592) 587 1,179 - $ (1,158) 21 ------- --------- ------- ------- ------- --------- ------- $ 3,580 $ (1,647) $ 1,933 $ 3,580 $ (966) $ (1,158) $ 1,456 ======= ========= ======= ======= ======= ========= ======= Related deferred tax assets of $626 and $599 were recorded at November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively, as a reduction to the unrealized holding loss included in accumulated other comprehensive loss. During 2000, the Company exercised its option to convert 800,000 Japanese yen of Shintom debentures into shares of Shintom common stock. The Company sold the Shintom common stock, yielding net proceeds of $12,376 and a gain of $1,850. During 2000, the Company sold 200,000 shares of its CellStar common stock yielding net proceeds of $851 and a gain of $537. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded a $1,158 other-than-temporary impairment of its Shintom common stock. During 2001 and 2002, the net unrealized holding loss on trading securities that has been included in earnings is $779 and $558, respectively. (Continued) 107
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (10) Property, Plant and Equipment A summary of property, plant and equipment, net, is as follows: November 30, -------------------------- 2001 2002 ---- ---- Land $ 4,493 $ 363 Buildings 4,168 1,605 Property under capital lease 7,246 7,142 Furniture, fixtures and displays 2,129 2,404 Machinery and equipment 6,590 8,204 Computer hardware and software 13,108 14,467 Automobiles 658 769 Leasehold improvements 4,117 4,305 --------- -------- 42,509 39,259 Less accumulated depreciation and amortization (16,822) (20,878) --------- --------- $ 25,687 $ 18,381 ========= ======== The amortization of the property under capital lease is included in depreciation and amortization expense. Computer software includes approximately $2,396 and $1,450 of unamortized costs as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively, related to the acquisition and installation of management information systems for internal use. Depreciation and amortization of plant and equipment amounted to $3,426, $4,174 and $4,768 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Included in accumulated depreciation and amortization is amortization of computer software costs of $702, $776 and $850 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Included in accumulated depreciation and amortization is amortization of property under capital lease of $240 for each of the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. (11) Equity Investments As of November 30, 2002, the Company's 72% owned subsidiary, Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd., had a 29% ownership interest in Avx Posse (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd. (Posse) which monitors car security commands through a satellite based system in Malaysia. In addition, the Company had a 20% ownership interest in Bliss-tel which distributes cellular telephones and accessories in Thailand, and the Company had 50% non-controlling ownership interests in three other entities: Protector Corporation (Protector) which acts as a distributor of chemical protection treatments; ASA which acts as a distributor to specialized markets for RV's and van conversions, of televisions and other automotive sound, security and accessory products; (Continued) 108
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED and G.L.M. Wireless Communications, Inc. (G.L.M.) which is in the cellular telephone, pager and communications business in the New York metropolitan area. During 2000, the Company entered into an agreement to cease the operations of its 50% owned investment in Audiovox Pacific Pty., Limited, which was a former distributor of cellular telephones and automotive sound and security products in Australia and New Zealand. Also during fiscal 2000, the Company entered into an agreement to transfer to the other equity partner its 50% ownership equity in Quintex West, which is in the cellular telephone and related communication products business, as well as the automotive after-market products business. No consideration was given or no gain or loss was recorded in connection with either of the above transactions as both equity investments had been previously written down, and the Company had no on-going obligations to the entities or the other equity partner. The Company previously held a 30.8% investment in TALK which was disposed of during fiscal 2000 (Notes 5 and 8). The Company's net sales to the equity investees amounted to $3,233, $2,656 and $3,504 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. The Company's purchases from the equity investees amounted to $119,444, $5,592 and $1,883 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. The Company recorded $1,432, $746 and $644 of outside representative commission expenses for activations and residuals generated by G.L.M. on the Company's behalf during fiscal year 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Included in accounts receivable at November 30, 2001 and 2002 are trade receivables due from its equity investments aggregating $561 and $817, respectively. At November 30, 2001 and 2002, included in accounts payable and other accrued expenses were obligations to equity investments aggregating $13 and $6, respectively. For the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, interest income earned on equity investment notes and other receivables approximated $602, $157 and $2, respectively. Interest expense on documentary acceptances payable to TALK approximated $11 in 2000. (Continued) 109
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The following summary financial information reflects the interest of ASA. Such summary financial information has been provided herein based upon the individual significance of this unconsolidated equity investment to the consolidated financial information of the Company. Furthermore, based upon the lack of significance to the consolidated financial information of the Company, no summary financial information for the Company's other equity investments has been provided herein: As of November 30, 2001 2002 ---- ---- Current assets $18,225 $20,533 Non-current assets 2,395 2,332 Current liabilities 2,794 3,447 Non-current liabilities - - Members' equity 17,826 19,418 Twelve Months Ended November 30, 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- Net sales $54,875 $63,336 $44,168 Operating income 2,617 5,581 216 Net income 4,011 6,908 3,486 The Company's share of income from this unconsolidated equity investment for the fiscal years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 was $2,006, $3,454 and $1,743, respectively. (12) Unearned Revenue As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet, is $8,314 and $0, respectively, of which represents prepayments for future product shipments. The Company recognized the revenue as product shipments were made. (13) Financing Arrangements (a) Bank Obligations The Company maintains a revolving credit agreement with various financial institutions which expires July 27, 2004. As of November 30, 2002, the credit agreement provided for $250,000 of available credit (which was subsequently amended on March 13, 2003 to provide for $200,000 of available credit), including $15,000 for foreign currency borrowings. (Continued) 110
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Under the credit agreement, the Company may obtain credit through direct borrowings and letters of credit. The obligations of the Company under the credit agreement are guaranteed by certain of the Company's subsidiaries and is secured by accounts receivable, inventory and the Company's shares of ACC. As of November 30, 2002, availability of credit under the credit agreement was a maximum aggregate amount of $250,000, subject to certain conditions, based upon a formula taking into account the amount and quality of its accounts receivable and inventory. At November 30, 2002, the amount of unused available credit is $102,491. The credit agreement also allows for commitments of $50,000 in forward exchange contracts. Outstanding short-term obligations under the credit agreement at November 30, 2001 and 2002 were as follows: November 30, ------------------------ 2001 2002 ---- ---- Revolving Credit Notes $13,525 $16,883 Eurodollar Notes 73,000 20,000 -------- ------- $86,525 $36,883 ======= ======= Interest rates are as follows: revolving credit notes at Prime Rate at November 30, 2000, 0.25% above the Prime Rate at November 30, 2001 and 0.50% above the Prime Rate at November 30, 2002 which was 9.5%, 5.5% and 4.8% at November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. Eurodollar Notes at 1.25% above Libor at November 30, 2000, 1.75% above Libor at November 30, 2001 and 2.50% above Libor at November 30, 2002 which was 6.8%, 3.4% and 3.9% at November 30, 2000, November 30, 2001 and November 30, 2002, respectively. The Company pays a commitment fee on the unused portion of the credit line. The credit agreement contains several covenants requiring, among other things, minimum levels of pre-tax income and minimum levels of net worth. Additionally, the agreement includes restrictions and limitations on payments of dividends, stock repurchases and capital expenditures. At May 31, 2001, November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, the Company was not in compliance with certain of its pre-tax income covenants. Furthermore, as of November 30, 2002, the Company was also not in compliance with the requirement to deliver audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year- end, and as of February 28, 2003, the requirement to deliver unaudited quarterly financial statements 45 days after the Company's quarter end. The Company received a waiver for the November 30, 2001 pre-tax income violation subsequent to its issuance of the November 30, 2001 financial statements. In addition, the Company received waivers for the May 31, 2001 and February 28, 2002 violations. (Continued) 111
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The Company has not received waivers for the November 30, 2002 violation of a particular pre-tax income covenant or delivery of audited financial statements 90 days after the Company's fiscal year-end. Accordingly, as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, the Company's outstanding domestic obligations of $86,525 and 36,883, have been classified as current on the accompanying consolidated financial statements, respectively. Management is in the process of requesting a waiver for the November 30, 2002 and February 28, 2003 violations. While the Company was able to obtain waivers for such violations in 2001 and the first quarter ended February 28, 2002, there can be no assurance that future negotiations with its lenders would be successful or that the Company will not violate covenants in the future, therefore, resulting in amounts outstanding to be payable upon demand. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company repaid its obligation of $36,883 in full resulting in bank obligations outstanding at May 15, 2003 of $0. This credit agreement has no cross covenants with the other credit facilities described below. The Company also has revolving credit facilities in Malaysia (Malaysian Credit Agreement) to finance additional working capital needs. As of November 30, 2002, the available line of credit for direct borrowing, letters of credit, bankers' acceptances and other forms of credit approximated $5,000. The credit facilities are partially secured by three standby letters of credit of $1,300, $800 and $800 and are payable upon demand or upon expiration of the standby letters of credit on January 15, 2003, August 31, 2003 and August 31, 2003, respectively. The obligations of the Company under the Malaysian Credit Agreement are also secured by the property and building owned by Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. Outstanding obligations under the Malaysian Credit Agreement at November 30, 2001 and 2002 were approximately $3,514 and $3,317, respectively. At November 30, 2001, interest on the credit facility ranged from 6.5% to 7.0%. At November 30, 2002, interest on the credit facility ranged from 4.75% to 6.0%. As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, Audiovox Venezuela had notes payable of approximately 1,622,834 and 0 Venezuelan Bolivars ($2,074 and $0 at November 30, 2001 and 2002) outstanding to a bank. Interest on the notes payable was 10.7%. The notes payable were secured by a standby letter of credit in the amount of $3,500 by the Company and was payable upon demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit on May 31, 2002. The Company has not extended this line of credit as of November 30, 2002. The Company also has a revolving credit facility in Brazil to finance additional working capital needs. The Brazilian credit facility is secured by the Company under a standby letter of credit in the amount of $200, which expires on December 9, 2002 and is payable on demand or upon expiration of the standby letter of credit. At November 30, 2001 and 2002, outstanding obligations under the credit facility were 254 and 172 Brazilian (Continued) 112
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Bolivars ($100 and $48), respectively, and interest on the credit facility ranged from 19% to 29%. At November 30, 2001, the Company had additional outstanding standby letters of credit aggregating $640 which expire on various dates from May 2003 to July 2003. The maximum month-end amounts outstanding under all bank borrowing facilities during the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $156,854, $94,291 and $59,222, respectively. Average borrowings during the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were $52,010, $49,692 and $21,747, respectively, and the weighted average interest rates were 8.9%, 8.2% and 9.1%, respectively. (b) Documentary Acceptances The Company had various unsecured documentary acceptance lines of credit available with suppliers to finance inventory purchases. The Company does not have written agreements specifying the terms and amounts available under the lines of credit. There were no documentary acceptances outstanding at November 30, 2001 and 2002. The maximum month-end documentary acceptances outstanding and average borrowings during the year ended November 30, 2002 was $0 and $85,473, respectively. (14) Notes Payable A summary of notes payable follows: November 30, -------------------- 2001 2002 ---- ---- Note payable due to Vitec (Note 5(b)) $ 4,051 - Note payable due to Pearl (Note 5(b)) 1,216 - ------- ----- $ 5,267 - ======= ===== The notes bear interest at 5% and are payable in equal monthly installments over a six-month period beginning in October 2000. As a result of the extension of Shintom's option to repurchase the Property or purchase all of the shares of stock of AX Japan (Note 5(b)), the commencement of repayment was delayed to April 2001 and again to March 2002. Accordingly, the notes payable have been classified as current in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001. In connection with the sale of the shares of Audiovox Japan, the notes have been eliminated from the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002. (Continued) 113
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (15) Long-Term Debt On March 15, 1994, the Company completed the sale of $65,000, 6 1/4% subordinated debentures due 2001 and entered into an indenture agreement. The subordinated debentures were convertible into shares of the Company's Class A common stock, par value $.01 per share at an initial conversion price of $17.70 per share, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances. The indenture agreement contained various covenants. The bonds were subject to redemption by the Company in whole, or in part, at any time after March 15, 1997, at certain specified amounts. On May 9, 1995, the Company issued warrants to certain beneficial holders of these subordinated debentures. During fiscal 2000, holders of the Company's $65,000, 6 1/4% subordinated convertible debentures exercised their option to convert $534 debentures for 30,170 shares of the Company's Class A common stock. As a result of this conversion and the conversions that took place prior to 2000, the remaining subordinated debentures of $486 was included as current installments of long-term debt at November 30, 2000. During 2001, the Company paid $486 to the remaining holders of the Company's subordinated convertible debentures as such there is no convertible debentures outstanding at November 30, 2001 or 2002. On October 20, 1994, the Company issued a note payable for 500,000 Japanese Yen to finance its investment in TALK (Note 4(c)). The note was scheduled to be repaid on October 20, 2004 and bore interest at 4.1%. The note could be repaid by cash payment or by giving 10,000 shares of its TALK investment to the lender. The lender had an option to acquire 2,000 shares of TALK held by the Company in exchange for releasing the Company from 20% of the face value of the note at any time after October 20, 1995. In October 2000, the Company exercised its option to repay the note by returning the 10,000 shares of its TALK investment to the lender. In connection with the transaction, the Company recognized an extraordinary gain in the amount of $2,189 representing the difference between the loan, which approximated $4,578, and the Company's recorded investment in TALK, which approximated $2,389, at the time of the transaction. On May 29, 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC. In connection with the transaction, an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) was issued to Toshiba. The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1 3/4% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003. The unpaid principle amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years. In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a maximum 25% interest in ACC. (Continued) 114
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (16) Income Taxes The components of income (loss) before the provision for (recovery of) income taxes are as follows: November 30, ----------------------------------------- 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Domestic Operations $39,317 $ (11,535) $(7,584) Foreign Operations 2,826 53 1,181 ------- --------- ------- $42,143 $ (11,482) $(6,403) ======= ========= ======= Total income tax expense (benefit) was allocated as follows: November 30, ------------------------------------ 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Statement of operations $15,766 $ (3,627) $12,932 Stockholders' equity: Unrealized holding gain (loss) on investment securities recognized for financial reporting purposes (6,202) (509) 260 Unrealized holding gain (loss) on equity collar recognized for financial reporting purposes 570 - - Income tax benefit of employee stock option exercises (1,270) - (17) ------- -------- ------- Total income tax expense (benefit) $ 8,864 $ (4,136) $13,175 ======= ======== ======= (Continued) 115
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The provision for (recovery of) income taxes is comprised of: Federal Foreign State Total ------- ------- ----- ----- 2000: As Restated Current $ 19,210 $ 656 $ 1,934 $ 21,800 Deferred (4,481) (704) (849) (6,034) -------- -------- -------- -------- $ 14,729 $ (48) $ 1,085 $ 15,766 ======== ======== ======== ======== 2001: As Restated Current $ (1,751) $ 359 $ 1,097 $ (295) Deferred (2,407) 153 (1,078) (3,332) -------- -------- -------- -------- $ (4,158) $ 512 $ 19 $ (3,627) ======== ======== ======== ======== 2002: Current $ (525) $ 1,604 $ 1,949 $ 3,028 Deferred 8,645 180 1,079 9,904 -------- -------- -------- -------- $ 8,120 $ 1,784 $ 3,028 $ 12,932 ======== ======== ======== ======== A reconciliation of the provision for income taxes computed at the Federal statutory rate to income (loss) before income taxes and minority interest and the actual provision for income taxes is as follows: November 30, ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2000 2001 2002 ---------------------- ------------------------- --------------------------- As Restated As Restated ---------------------- ------------------------- Tax provision at Federal statutory rates $14,750 35.0% $(4,019) (35.0)% $(2,241) (35.0)% State income taxes, net of Federal benefit 705 1.7 12 0.1 338 5.3 Increase (decrease) in beginning- of-the-year balance of the valuation allowance for deferred tax assets (1,041) (2.5) (227) (2.0) 13,090 204.4 Foreign tax rate differential (59) (0.1) 448 4.0 1,372 21.4 Permanent and other, net 1,411 3.3 159 1.3 373 5.9 ------- ----- ------- ------- ------- ----- $15,766 37.4% $(3,627) (31.6)% $12,932 202.0% ======= ===== ======= ======= ======= ===== (Continued) 116
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The significant components of deferred income tax (recovery) expense for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 are as follows: November 30, --------------------------- 2001 2002 ---- ---- As Restated ----------- Deferred tax expense (recovery) (exclusive of the effect of other components listed below) $ (3,105) $ (3,186) Increase (decrease) in beginning-of-the-year balance of the valuation allowance for deferred tax assets (227) 13,090 --------- ---------- $ (3,332) $ 9,904 ========= ========== The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and deferred liabilities are presented below: November 30, --------------------------- 2001 2002 ---- ---- As Restated ----------- Deferred tax assets: Accounts receivable, principally due to allowance for doubtful accounts and cellular deactivations $ 1,971 $ 1,723 Inventory, principally due to additional costs capitalized for tax purposes pursuant to the Tax Reform Act of 1986 1,043 1,617 Inventory, principally due to valuation reserve 5,421 7,521 Accrual for future warranty costs 3,241 3,249 Plant, equipment and certain intangibles, principally due to depreciation and amortization 1,442 1,863 Net operating loss carryforwards, federal, state and foreign 870 4,926 Foreign tax credits - 1,347 Accrued liabilities not currently deductible and other 746 520 Investment securities 463 719 Deferred compensation plans 1,492 1,537 -------- -------- Total gross deferred tax assets 16,689 25,022 Less: valuation allowance (116) (13,206) -------- --------- Net deferred tax assets 16,573 11,816 -------- -------- Deferred tax liabilities: Issuance of subsidiary shares (1,460) (6,867) -------- --------- Total gross deferred tax liabilities (1,460) (6,867) -------- --------- Net deferred tax asset $ 15,113 $ 4,949 ======== ======== (Continued) 117
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The net change in the total valuation allowance for the year ended November 30, 2002 was an increase of $13,090, primarily resulting from a valuation allowance recorded on certain of ACC's deferred tax assets. After this valuation allowance, the net deferred tax assets remaining on the consolidated balance sheet represent deferred tax assets generated from the Electronics Group. A valuation allowance is provided when it is more likely than not that some portion, or all, of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Based on the Electronics Group's ability to carry back future reversals of deferred tax assets to taxes paid in current and prior years and the Electronics Group's historical taxable income record, adjusted for unusual items, management believes it is more likely than not that the Electronics Group will realize the benefit of the net deferred tax assets existing at November 30, 2002. Further, management believes the existing net deductible temporary differences will reverse during periods in which the Electronics Group generates net taxable income. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will generate any earnings or any specific level of continuing earnings in the future. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable by the Electronics Group, therefore, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced. At November 30, 2002, the Wireless Group had a net operating loss carryforward for federal income tax purposes of approximately $7,468, which is available to offset future taxable income, if any, which will expire through the year ended November 30, 2022. (17) Capital Structure The Company's capital structure is as follows: Voting Rights Par Shares Per Liquidation Security Value Shares Authorized Outstanding Share Rights -------- ----- ------------------------------ ------------------------------ ----- ------ November 30, November 30, ------------------------------ ------------------------------ 2001 2002 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- ---- $50 per Preferred Stock $50.00 50,000 50,000 50,000 50,000 - share Series Preferred Stock 0.01 1,500,000 1,500,000 - - - - Ratably with Class A Common Stock 0.01 60,000,000 60,000,000 19,706,309 19,559,445 One Class B Ratably with Class B Common Stock 0.01 10,000,000 10,000,000 2,260,954 2,260,954 Ten Class A (Continued) 118
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The holders of Class A and Class B common stock are entitled to receive cash or property dividends declared by the Board of Directors. The Board can declare cash dividends for Class A common stock in amounts equal to or greater than the cash dividends for Class B common stock. Dividends other than cash must be declared equally for both classes. Each share of Class B common stock may, at any time, be converted into one share of Class A common stock. The 50,000 shares of non-cumulative Preferred Stock outstanding are owned by Shintom (see Notes 5 and 9) and have preference over both classes of common stock in the event of liquidation or dissolution. The Company's Board of Directors approved the repurchase of 1,563,000 shares of the Company's Class A common stock in the open market under a share repurchase program (the Program). As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 909,537 and 1,072,737 shares, respectively, were repurchased under the Program at an average price of $8.12 and $7.93 per share, respectively, for an aggregate amount of $7,386 and $8,511, respectively. As of November 30, 2001 and 2002, 2,916,653 and 2,900,317 shares of the Company's Class A common stock are reserved for issuance under the Company's Stock Option and Restricted Stock Plans. There were no convertible securities or warrants outstanding for the Company at November 30, 2001 and 2002 (Notes 15 and 18(d)). Warrants are outstanding that may be converted into shares of Code (Note 6). In February 2000, the Company sold, pursuant to an underwritten public offering, 2,300,000 shares of its Class A common stock at a price of $45.00 per share. The Company received $96,573 in net proceeds after deducting underwriting commission and offering expenses. The net proceeds from the offering were used to repay a portion of amounts outstanding under the revolving credit facility. On April 6, 2000, the stockholders approved a proposal to amend the Company's Certificate of Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of Class A common stock, par value $.01, from 30,000,000 to 60,000,000. Undistributed earnings from equity investments included in retained earnings amounted to $3,742 and $4,496 at November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. (18) Stock-Based Compensation and Retirement Plans (a) Stock Options The Company has stock option plans under which employees and non-employee directors may be granted incentive stock options (ISO's) and non-qualified stock options (NQSO's) (Continued) 119
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED to purchase shares of Class A common stock. Under the plans, the exercise price of the ISO's will not be less than the market value of the Company's Class A common stock or greater than 110% of the market value of the Company's Class A common stock on the date of grant. The exercise price of the NQSO's may not be less than 50% of the market value of the Company's Class A common stock on the date of grant. The options must be exercisable no later than ten years after the date of grant. The vesting requirements are determined by the Board of Directors at the time of grant. Compensation expense is recorded with respect to the options based upon the quoted market value of the shares and the exercise provisions at the date of grant. No compensation expense was recorded for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002. Information regarding the Company's stock options is summarized below: Weighted Average Number Exercise of Shares Price --------- ----- Outstanding at November 30, 1999 2,871,200 11.41 Granted - - Exercised (121,300) 6.84 Canceled - - ---------- ------ Outstanding at November 30, 2000 2,749,900 11.61 Granted - - Exercised (10,000) 7.69 Canceled - - --------- ------ Outstanding at November 30, 2001 2,739,900 11.62 ========= ====== Granted - - Exercised (16,336) 7.69 Canceled (12,500) 13.75 --------- ------ Outstanding at November 30, 2002 2,711,064 11.64 ========= ====== Options exercisable at November 30, 2002 2,711,064 11.64 ========= ====== At November 30, 2001 and 2002, 176,753 and 189,253 shares, respectively, were available for future grants under the terms of these plans. There were no options granted during 2000, 2001 and 2002. The Company applies APB No. 25 in accounting for its stock option grants and, accordingly, no compensation cost has been recognized in the financial statements for its stock options which have an exercise price equal to or greater than the fair value (Continued) 120
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED of the stock on the date of the grant. Had the Company determined compensation cost based on the fair value at the grant date for its stock options under Statement 123, the Company's net income (loss) and net income (loss) per common share would have been reduced to the pro-forma amounts indicated below: 2000 2001 2002 -------- --------- ---------- Restated Restated -------- -------- Net income (loss): As reported $27,492 $ (7,198) $(14,040) Stock based compensation expense 4,434 2,287 864 ------- --------- -------- Pro-forma $23,058 $ (9,485) $(14,904) ======= ========= ======== Net income (loss) per common share (basic): As reported $ 1.29 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) Pro-forma 1.08 (0.43) (0.68) Net income (loss) per common share (diluted): As reported $ 1.22 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) Pro-forma 1.02 (0.43) (0.68) Pro-forma net income (loss) reflect only options granted after November 30, 1995. Therefore, the full impact of calculating compensation cost for stock options under Statement 123 is not reflected in the pro-forma net income (loss) amounts presented above because compensation cost is reflected over the options' vesting period and compensation cost for options granted prior to December 1, 1995 was not considered. Therefore, the pro-forma net income (loss) may not be representative of the effects on reported net income (loss) for future years. Summarized information about stock options outstanding as of November 30, 2002 is as follows: Outstanding Exercisable -------------------------------------------------- ----------------------------- Weighted Weighted Average Average Weighted Exercise Exercise Life Number Average Price Number Price Remaining of Price Range of Shares of Shares In Years Shares of Shares ------------------ -------------- -------------- -------------- ------------ ------------- $4.63 - $8.00 1,122,864 $ 7.21 4.21 1,122,864 $ 7.21 $8.01 - $13.00 108,200 $11.61 2.34 108,200 $11.61 $13.01 - $15.00 1,480,000 $15.00 6.78 1,480,000 $15.00 (Continued) 121
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (b) Restricted Stock Plan The Company has restricted stock plans under which key employees and directors may be awarded restricted stock. Total restricted stock outstanding, granted under these plans, at November 30, 1999 was 13,750. There were no restricted stock outstanding at November 30, 2000. Awards under the restricted stock plan may be performance- accelerated shares or performance-restricted shares. During fiscal 2000, 6,825 performance-accelerated shares and 4,846 performance- restricted shares were granted. During fiscal 2000, 1,979 performance-restricted shares lapsed (were not earned). There were no performance-restricted accelerated shares or performance-restricted shares granted in 2001 and 2002. Compensation expense for the performance-accelerated shares is recorded based upon the quoted market value of the shares on the date of grant. Compensation expense for the performance- restricted shares is recorded based upon the quoted market value of the shares on the balance sheet date. Compensation expense (income) for these grants for the year ended November 30, 2000 was $40. (c) Employee Stock Purchase Plan In April 2000, the stockholders approved the 2000 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The stock purchase plan provides eligible employees an opportunity to purchase shares of the Company's Class A common stock through payroll deductions at a minimum of 2% and a maximum of 15% of base salary compensation. Amounts withheld are used to purchase Class A common stock on the open market. The cost to the employee for the shares is equal to 85% of the fair market value of the shares on or about the quarterly purchase date (December 31, March 31, June 30 or September 30). The Company bears the cost of the remaining 15% of the fair market value of the shares as well as any broker fees. This Plan provides for purchases of up to 1,000,000 shares. The Company's employee stock purchase plan is a compensatory plan, in accordance with APB No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees", for which the related expense is recorded in the consolidated statement of operations. Accordingly, there would be no impact to the Company's proforma information in accordance with SFAS 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" (Note 18(a)). (d) Stock Warrants At November 30, 2000, 344,800 warrants, convertible into Class A Common Stock at $7 1/8, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances, were outstanding. During 2001, 314,800 warrants were exercised and converted into 314,800 shares of common stock. The remaining 30,000 warrants expired in 2001. (Continued) 122
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (e) Stock Appreciation Units In May 2002, the Company granted seven stock appreciation units in ACC to its Chief Executive Officer. Each unit has a value of approximately $774, which was based upon the then fair value per share of ACC based upon the value of shares sold to Toshiba (Note 3). Each stock appreciation unit equals the value of one ACC share. All of these units vested upon the date of grant, however, all of these units are contingent upon the following future events (i) an initial public offering of ACC or (ii) a change of control of ACC as defined. Further, as these specified events were not considered probable at the grant date, fixed award accounting was followed. (f) Profit Sharing Plans The Company has established two non-contributory employee profit sharing plans for the benefit of its eligible employees in the United States and Canada. The plans are administered by trustees appointed by the Company. Accruals for contributions of $1,000 and $300 were recorded by the Company for the United States plan in fiscal 2000 and 2001, respectively. No accruals for contributions were recorded by the Company in fiscal 2002. Contributions required by law to be made for eligible employees in Canada were not material. (g) Deferred Compensation Plan Effective December 1, 1999, the Company adopted a Deferred Compensation Plan (the Plan) for a select group of management. The Plan is intended to provide certain executives with supplemental retirement benefits as well as to permit the deferral of more of their compensation than they are permitted to defer under the Profit Sharing and 401(k) Plan. The Plan provides for a matching contribution equal to 25% of the employee deferrals up to $20. The Plan is not intended to be a qualified plan under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code. All compensation deferred under the Plan is held by the Company in an investment trust which is considered an asset of the Company. The investments, which amounted to $3,949 at November 30, 2002, have been classified as trading securities and are included in investment securities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002. The return on these underlying investments will determine the amount of earnings credited to the employees. The Company has the option of amending or terminating the Plan at any time. The deferred compensation liability is reflected as a long-term liability on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2002. Compensation expense and investment income are recorded in the accompanying consolidated statement (Continued) 123
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED of operations in connection with this deferred compensation plan. (19) Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) The change in net unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities of $(10,119), $(831) and $422 for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 is net of tax of $(6,202), $(509) and $260, respectively. A reclassification adjustment, net of tax, of $1,480 is included in the net unrealized gain (loss) on marketable securities for the year ended November 30, 2000 and was transferred from other comprehensive income (loss) to gain on sale of investments on the accompanying consolidated statement of operations. There were no reclassification adjustments for the year ended November 30, 2001 and 2002. The currency translation adjustments are not adjusted for income taxes as they relate to indefinite investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries and equity investments. (20) Net Income (Loss) Per Common Share A reconciliation between the numerators and denominators of the basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share is as follows: For the Years Ended November 30, --------------------------------------------- 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Net income (loss) (numerator for net income per common share, basic) $ 27,492 $ (7,198) $ (14,040) Interest on 6 1/4% convertible subordinated debentures, net of tax 28 5 - ----------- ------------ ----------- Adjusted net income (loss) (numerator for net income per common share, diluted) $ 27,520 $ (7,203) $ (14,040) =========== ============ ========== Weighted average common shares (denominator for net income (loss) per common share, basic) 21,393,566 21,877,100 21,850,035 Effect of dilutive securities: Employee stock options and stock warrants 1,129,896 - - Employee stock grants - - - Convertible debentures 42,344 - - ----------- ------------ ----------- Weighted average common and potential common shares outstanding (denominator for net income (loss) per common share, diluted) 22,565,806 21,877,100 21,850,035 =========== ============ =========== Net income (loss) per common share before extraordinary item and cumulative effect: Basic $ 1.19 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) =========== ============ =========== Diluted $ 1.12 $ (0.33) $ (0.65) =========== ============ =========== Net income (loss) per common share: Basic $ 1.29 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) =========== ============ =========== Diluted $ 1.22 $ (0.33) $ (0.64) =========== ============ =========== (Continued) 124
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Employee stock options and stock warrants totaling 2,173,000 and 2,595,108 for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 were not included in the net income (loss) per common share calculation because their effect would have been anti-dilutive. (21) Lease Obligations During 1998, the Company entered into a 30-year lease for a building with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer. A significant portion of the lease payments, as required under the lease agreement, consists of the debt service payments required to be made by the principal stockholder in connection with the financing of the construction of the building. For financial reporting purposes, the lease has been classified as a capital lease, and, accordingly, a building and the related obligation of approximately $6,340 was recorded (Note 24). The effective interest rate on the capital lease obligation is 8.0%. During 1998, the Company entered into a sale/lease back transaction with its principal stockholder and chief executive officer for $2,100 of equipment. No gain or loss on the transaction was recorded as the book value of the equipment equaled the fair market value. The lease is for five years with monthly rental payments of $34. The lease has been classified as an operating lease. At November 30, 2002, the Company was obligated under non-cancelable capital and operating leases for equipment and warehouse facilities for minimum annual rental payments as follows: Capital Operating Lease Leases 2003 $ 554 $ 1,983 2004 553 1,246 2005 552 1,113 2006 561 821 2007 577 628 Thereafter 11,409 889 ------- ------- Total minimum lease payments 14,206 $ 6,680 ======= Less: amount representing interest 8,010 ------- Present value of net minimum lease payments 6,196 Less: current installments included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities 55 ------- Long-term obligation $ 6,141 ======= Rental expense for the above-mentioned operating lease agreements and other leases on a month- to-month basis approximated $2,642, $2,958 and $3,191 for the years ended November 30, (Continued) 125
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. The Company leases certain facilities and equipment from its principal stockholder and several officers. Rentals for such leases are considered by management of the Company to approximate prevailing market rates. At November 30, 2002, minimum annual rental payments on these related party leases, in addition to the capital lease payments, which are included in the above table, are as follows: 2003 $ 961 2004 307 2005 322 2006 333 2007 343 Thereafter 473 (22) Financial Instruments (a) Off-Balance Sheet Risk Commercial letters of credit are issued by the Company during the ordinary course of business through major domestic banks as requested by certain suppliers. The Company also issues standby letters of credit principally to secure certain bank obligations of Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela (Note 13(a)). The Company had open commercial letters of credit of approximately $37,635 and $8,129, of which $16,834 and $3,740 were accrued for purchases incurred as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, respectively. The terms of these letters of credit are all less than one year. No material loss is anticipated due to nonperformance by the counter parties to these agreements. The fair value of these open commercial and standby letters of credit is estimated to be the same as the contract values based on the nature of the fee arrangements with the issuing banks. The Company is a party to joint and several guarantees on behalf of G.L.M. which aggregate $300. There is no market for these guarantees and they were issued without explicit cost. Therefore, it is not practicable to establish its fair value. (b) Concentrations of Credit Risk Financial instruments, which potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk, consist principally of trade receivables. The Company's customers are located principally in the United States and Canada and consist of, among others, wireless carriers and service providers, distributors, agents, mass merchandisers, warehouse clubs and independent retailers. (Continued) 126
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED At November 30, 2001 and 2002, one customer, a wireless carrier and service provider, accounted for approximately 28% and 27% of accounts receivable, respectively. During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, one customer accounted for approximately 50.5%, 35% and 24% of the Company's 2000, 2001 and 2002 sales, respectively. The Company generally grants credit based upon analyses of its customers' financial position and previously established buying and payment patterns. The Company establishes collateral rights in accounts receivable and inventory and obtains personal guarantees from certain customers based upon management's credit evaluation. A portion of the Company's customer base may be susceptible to downturns in the retail economy, particularly in the consumer electronics industry. Additionally, customers specializing in certain automotive sound, security and accessory products may be impacted by fluctuations in automotive sales. (c) Fair Value The carrying value of all financial instruments classified as a current asset or liability is deemed to approximate fair value because of the short term maturity of these instruments. The estimated fair value of the Company's financial instruments is as follows: November 30, 2001 November 30, 2002 ----------------------------- ----------------------------- Carrying Fair Carrying Fair Amount Value Amount Value -------------- ------------- ------------- ------------- Investment securities $ 5,777 $ 5,777 $ 5,405 $ 5,405 Long-term obligations $86,525 $86,525 $36,883 $36,883 The following methods and assumptions were used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instruments for which it is practicable to estimate that value: Investment Securities The carrying amount represents fair value, which is based upon quoted market prices at the reporting date (Note 9). Long-Term Obligations The carrying amount of bank debt under the Company's revolving credit agreement approximates fair value because the interest rate on the bank debt is reset every quarter (Continued) 127
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED to reflect current market rates. Limitations Fair value estimates are made at a specific point in time, based on relevant market information and information about the financial instrument. These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and, therefore, cannot be determined with precision. Changes in assumptions could significantly affect the estimates. (23) Segment Information The Company has two reportable segments which are organized by products: Wireless and Electronics. The Wireless segment markets wireless handsets and accessories through domestic and international wireless carriers and their agents, independent distributors and retailers. The Electronics segment sells autosound, mobile electronics and consumer electronics, primarily to mass merchants, specialty retailers, new car dealers, original equipment manufacturers (OEM), independent installers of automotive accessories and the U.S. military. The Company evaluates performance of the segments based upon income before provision for income taxes. The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies (Note 1). The Company allocates interest and certain shared expenses, including treasury, legal and human resources, to the segments based upon estimated usage. Intersegment sales are reflected at cost and have been eliminated in consolidation. A royalty fee on the intersegment sales, which is eliminated in consolidation, is recorded by the segments and included in other income (expense). Certain items are maintained at the Company's corporate headquarters (Corporate) and are not allocated to the segments. They primarily include costs associated with accounting and certain executive officer salaries and bonuses and certain items including investment securities, equity investments, deferred income taxes, certain portions of excess cost over fair value of assets acquired, jointly-used fixed assets and debt. The jointly-used fixed assets are the Company's management information systems, which is jointly used by the Wireless and Electronics segments and Corporate. A portion of the management information systems costs, including depreciation and amortization expense, are allocated to the segments based upon estimates made by management. Segment identifiable assets are those which are directly used in or identified to segment operations. During the year ended November 30, 2000, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 50.5% of the Company's 2000 sales. During the year ended November 30, 2001, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 35.0% of the Company's 2001 sales. During the year ended November 30, 2002, one customer of the Wireless segment accounted for approximately 24% of the Company's consolidated 2002 sales. No customers in the Electronics segment exceeded 10% of consolidated sales in fiscal 2000, 2001 or 2002. (Continued) 128
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Consolidated Wireless Electronics Corporate Totals -------- ----------- --------- ------ 2000, As Restated - ----------------- Net sales 1,393,820 276,471 - 1,670,291 Intersegment sales (purchases), net 302 (302) - - Interest income 198 104 1,314 1,616 Interest expense 7,752 2,551 (4,729) 5,574 Depreciation and amortization 789 1,285 2,054 4,128 Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and extraordinary item 30,219 16,632 (4,708) 42,143 Extraordinary item - - 2,189 2,189 Total assets 312,593 138,827 66,166 517,586 Goodwill, net - 426 4,648 5,074 Non-cash items: Provision for bad debt expense 1,946 758 (185) 2,519 Deferred income tax (benefit) - - 6,034 (6,034) Minority interest - - 3,555 3,555 Capital expenditures 1,241 1,890 9,944 13,075 2001, As Restated - ----------------- Net sales 978,888 297,703 - 1,276,591 Interest income 138 91 441 670 Interest expense 7,711 2,039 (4,575) 5,175 Depreciation and amortization 878 1,408 2,190 4,476 Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and extraordinary item (17,656) 13,623 (7,449) (11,482) Total assets 347,393 138,779 58,325 544,497 Goodwill, net - 370 4,362 4,732 Non-cash items: Provision for bad debt expense 629 1,091 216 1,936 Deferred income tax (benefit) - - (3,332) (3,332) Minority interest - - 1,830 1,830 Capital expenditures 1,082 992 795 2,869 2002 - ---- Net sales 727,658 372,724 - 1,100,382 Interest income 81 169 259 509 Interest expense 3,984 1,605 (2,409) 3,180 Depreciation and amortization 1,114 1,571 2,095 4,780 Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income tax, minority interest, and cumulative effect (24,906) 17,415 1,088 (6,403) Total assets 304,337 209,231 37,667 551,235 Goodwill, net - 2,224 4,602 6,826 Non-cash items: Provision for bad debt expense 3,482 1,402 - 4,884 Deferred income tax expense - - 9,904 9,904 Minority interest - - 4,616 4,616 Capital expenditures 1,093 1,321 745 3,159 129
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED In accordance with SFAS No. 142, Corporate wrote-off its unamortized negative goodwill of $240 as of the date of adoption, which has been reflected in the consolidated statements of operations as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle for the year ended November 30, 2002. The implementation of SFAS No. 142 was immaterial to the segments. Goodwill in the amount of $284 was acquired in March 2002 in connection with the purchase of certain assets of Code-Alarm, Inc. by Code Systems, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Audiovox Electronics Corp. (Note 6). Net sales and long-lived assets by location for the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 were as follows. Net Sales Long-Lived Assets ------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------------------------ 2000 2001 2002 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- United States $1,424,077 $1,061,853 $ 867,154 $43,541 $34,820 $40,506 Canada 68,004 85,796 143,368 - - - Argentina 17,888 2,684 985 - - - Peru - 4,148 313 - - - Portugal 7,679 - - - - - Japan - - - 7,387 6,545 - Malaysia 15,294 12,570 11,637 849 1,220 1,038 Venezuela 15,264 22,422 16,744 644 8,339 852 Mexico, Central America and Caribbean 100,599 77,134 28,655 - - - Chile 15,794 1,077 21,711 - - - Other foreign countries 5,692 8,907 9,815 - - - ---------- ---------- ---------- ------- ------- -------- Total $1,670,291 $1,276,591 $1,100,382 $52,421 $50,924 $ 42,396 ========== ========== ========== ======= ======= ======== (24) Related Party Transactions During 2000, the Company advanced $620 to an officer/director of the Company which has been included in prepaid expenses and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and obtained an unsecured note. The note was paid in full during fiscal 2002. In addition, the Company has outstanding notes due from various officers of the Company aggregating $235 as of November 30, 2002, which have been included in prepaid and other current assets on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet. The notes bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 0.5% per annum. Principle and interest are payable in equal annual installments beginning July 1, 1999 through July 1, 2003. (Continued) 130
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The Company also leases certain facilities and equipment from its principal stockholder and several officers (Note 21). In April 2000, the Company entered into a sale/leaseback transaction with Shintom (Note 5(b)). Toshiba was a 5% stockholder in ACC (Note 5). During the years ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002, 48%, 34% and 38% of the Company's purchases, respectively, were from Toshiba (Note 5). During the quarter ended November 30, 2001, the Company recorded a receivable in the amount of $4,550 from Toshiba for upgrades that were performed by the Company in 2001 on certain models which Toshiba manufactured. Subsequent to November 30, 2001, the amount was received in full. At November 30, 2002, the Company recorded receivables from Toshiba aggregating approximately $12,219 for price protection and software upgrades. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the amounts were paid in full. At November 30, 2002, the Company had on hand 504,200 units in the amount of $91,226, which has been recorded in inventory and accounts payable on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet. Of this accounts payable, $56,417 is subject to an arrangement with the manufacturer of the phones, which provides for, among other things, extended payment terms. The payment terms are such that the payable is non-interest bearing, and the Company is not required to pay for the phones until shipment has been made to the Company's customers. The remaining $34,809 of the $91,226 accounts payable is payable in accordance with the terms established in a distribution agreement with the vendor, which is 30 days. For certain inventory items, the Company is entitled to receive price protection in the event the selling price to its customers is less than the purchase price from the manufacturer. The Company records such price protection, as necessary, at the time of the sale of the units. As of November 30, 2002, such price protection amounted to $32,643, of which $27,683 was recorded as a reduction to cost of sales as the related inventory was sold. The other $4,960 in price protection for 2002 has been reflected as a reduction to the remaining inventory cost. On May 29, 2002, Toshiba purchased an additional 20% of ACC for $23,900 in cash, bringing Toshiba's total ownership interest in ACC to 25%. In addition, an $8,100 convertible subordinated note (the Note) was issued to Toshiba. The Note bears interest at a per annum rate equal to 1 3/4% and interest is payable annually on May 31st of each year, commencing May 31, 2003. The unpaid principle amount shall be due and payable, together with all unpaid interest, on May 31, 2007 and automatically renews for an additional five years. In accordance with the provisions of the Note, Toshiba may convert the balance of the Note into additional shares of ACC in order to maintain a maximum 25% interest in ACC. In connection with the transaction, ACC and Toshiba formalized a distribution agreement whereby ACC will be Toshiba's exclusive distributor for the sale of Toshiba products in the United States, Canada, Mexico and all countries in the Caribbean and Central and South America through May 29, 2007. Also, in accordance with the terms of the stockholders agreement, (Continued) 131
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED upon the termination of the distribution agreement in accordance with certain terms of the distribution agreement. Pursuant to the agreement, the put right is only exercisable if ACC terminates the distribution agreement or if another strategic investor acquires a direct or indirect equity ownership interest in excess of 20% in the Company. Toshiba maintains a put right and the Company a call right, to repurchase all of the shares held by the other party for a price equal to the fair market value of the shares as calculated in accordance with the agreement. Audiovox's call right is only exercisable if Toshiba elects to terminate the distribution agreement after its initial five (5) year term. The Company engages in transactions with Shintom and TALK (Note 5). (25) Commitments and Contingencies Contingencies The Company is currently, and has in the past been, a party to routine litigation incidental to its business. From time to time, the Company receives notification of alleged violations of registered patent holders' rights. The Company has either been indemnified by its manufacturers in these matters, obtained the benefit of a patent license, or has decided to vigorously defend such claims. For one such patent claim, the Company has recorded an accrual of approximately $496 which represents a settlement offer that has been put forward by the Company to settle this matter. However, the Company can give no assurances that this particular legal matter can be settled for this amount. On November 6, 2002, Audiovox Electronics Corporation ("AEC") was served with a summons and complaint in an action for patent infringement that was instituted by a certain party against AEC in the United State District Court for the Southern District of New York. The complaint seeks equitable relief and damages for alleged infringement of a patent. AEC has meritorious defenses to this claim and intends to vigorously defend this action. However, the Company cannot be certain of the outcome of this matter. Subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company and Audiovox Communications Corp. ("ACC"), along with other manufacturers of wireless phones and cellular service providers, were named as defendants in two class action lawsuits alleging non-compliance with FCC ordered emergency 911 call processing capabilities. There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date. These lawsuits have been consolidated and transferred to the United States District Court for the Northern District of Illinois. The Company and ACC intend to vigorously defend this matter. However, no assurances regarding the outcome of this matter can be given at this point in the litigation. Also, subsequent to November 30, 2002, the Company was named in a class action lawsuit alleging non-compliance with emergency 911 call processing capabilities. The Company intends to defend itself vigorously in this matter. However, no assurances regarding the outcome of (Continued) 132
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED this matter can be given at this time. During 2001, the Company, along with other suppliers, manufacturers and distributors of hand- held wireless telephones, was named as a defendant in five class action lawsuits alleging damages relating to exposure to radio frequency radiation from hand-held wireless telephones. These class actions have been consolidated and transferred to a Multi-District Litigation Panel before the United States District Court of the District of Maryland. On March 5, 2003, Judge Catherine C. Blake of the United States District Court for the District of Maryland granted the defendants' consolidated motion to dismiss these complaints. Plaintiffs have appealed to the United States Circuit Court of Appeals, Fourth Circuit. It is anticipated that the appeal will be heard in late 2003 or early 2004. There are various procedural motions pending and no discovery has been conducted to date. The Company has asserted indemnification claims against the manufacturers of the hand-held wireless telephones. The Company is vigorously defending these class action lawsuits. In July 2002, Audiovox Communications Corp. instituted suit against Northcoast Communications, LLC in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of Suffolk seeking recovery of the sum of $1,818 as the balance due it for cellular telephones sold and delivered. In its answer Northcoast interposed counterclaims including fraud, negligent misrepresentation and breach of contract seeking damages in excess of $10,000. The parties have recently served discovery demands and no depositions have been taken to date. Based on discussions with management and review of Audiovox's documents, Northcoast's counterclaims appear to be without merit and interposed to avoid payment of the underlying indebtedness. The Company is the subject of an administrative agency investigation involving alleged reimbursement of a fixed nominal amount of federal campaign contributions during the years 1995 through 1996. The Company has fully cooperated with the investigation and believes that it has committed no wrongdoing. The Company does not expect the outcome of any pending litigation, separately and in the aggregate, to have a material adverse effect on its business, consolidated financial position or results of operations. Commitments The Company has guaranteed a $300 line of credit with a financial institution on behalf of one of its equity investments and has established standby letters of credit to guarantee the bank obligations of Audiovox Communications Sdn. Bhd. and Audiovox Venezuela (Note 13(a)). (Continued) 133
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED (26) Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data - As Restated Selected unaudited, quarterly financial data of the Company for the years ended November 30, 2001 and 2002 appears below: QUARTER ENDED (Dollars in thousands, except per share data) Feb. 28 May 31 Aug. 31 Nov. 30 ------- ------ ------- ------- (As Restated) (As Restated) (As Restated) (As Restated) 2001 - ---- Net sales 348,047 276,581 310,811 341,152 Gross profit 23,861 5,393 24,001 18,135 Operating expenses 18,913 18,997 21,470 21,246 Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest 5,552 (13,891) 1,248 (4,393) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes 2,029 (5,024) 540 (1,169) Minority interest income (expense) (170) 562 121 147 Net income (loss) 3,353 (8,305) 829 (3,077) Net income (loss) per common share: Basic 0.15 (0.38) 0.04 (0.14) Diluted 0.15 (0.38) 0.04 (0.14) QUARTER ENDED (Dollars in thousands, except per share data) Feb. 28 May 31 Aug. 31 Nov. 30 ------- ------ ------- ------- (As Restated) (As Restated) (As Restated) 2002 - ---- Net sales 184,269 297,267 301,992 316,853 Gross profit 13,723 18,653 27,468 14,755 Operating expenses 18,946 24,089 21,283 24,356 Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest, and cumulative effect (7,554) 7,993 4,985 11,571 Provision for (recovery of) income taxes (1,500) 4,320 2,416 7,696 Minority interest income (expense) 557 257 49 4,193 Income (loss) before cumulative effect (5,497) 3,673 2,618 (15,074) Cumulative effect 240 - - - Net income (loss) (5,257) 3,673 2,618 (15,074) Net income (loss) per common share before cumulative effect: Basic (0.25) 0.17 0.12 (0.69) Diluted (0.25) 0.17 0.12 (0.69) Net income (loss) Basic (0.24) 0.17 0.12 (0.69) Diluted (0.24) 0.17 0.12 (0.69) 134
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED The following selected unaudited, quarterly financial data of the Company for all quarters in fiscal 2001 and the first three quarters of fiscal 2002 have been restated (see Note 2). FISCAL 2001 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED FEBRUARY 28, ------------------------------------------------------------------------ RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED (1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 328,302 $ 19,745(2)(5) - $ 348,047 Cost of sales 301,212 18,387(2) $ 4,587(3) 324,186 ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Gross profit 27,090 1,358 (4,587) 23,861 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,021 - - 7,021 General and administrative 11,134 - (144)(3) 10,990 Warehousing and technical support 5,345 - (4,443)(3) 902 ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Total operating expenses 23,500 - (4,587) 18,913 ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Operating income 3,590 1,358 - 4,948 Total other income (expense), net 604 - - 604 ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest 4,194 1,358 - 5,552 Provision for income taxes 1,458 571(4) - 2,029 Minority interest (170) - - (170) ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Net income $ 2,566 $ 787 - $ 3,353 =========== =========== =========== ========== Net income per common share (basic) $ 0.12 $ 0.03 - $ 0.15 =========== =========== =========== ========== Net income per common share (diluted) $ 0.12 $ 0.03 - $ 0.15 =========== =========== =========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,654,486 21,654,486 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 22,034,838 22,034,838 ========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (a) revenue recognition. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. 135
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2001 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MAY 31, --------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED(1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 276,814 $ (233)(4) - $ 276,581 Cost of sales 266,090 - $ 5,098(2) 271,188 ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Gross profit 10,724 (233) (5,098) 5,393 ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,372 - - 7,372 General and administrative 10,577 190 (147)(2) 10,620 Warehousing and technical support 5,956 - (4,951)(2) 1,005 ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Total operating expenses 23,905 190 (5,098) 18,997 ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Operating income (loss) (13,181) (423) - (13,604) Total other income (expense), net (287) - - (287) ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest (13,468) 423(5) - (13,891) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes (4,649) (375)(3) - (5,024) Minority interest 556 6(5) - 562 ---------- ------- ----------- ----------- Net income (loss) $ (8,263) $ (42) - $ (8,305) ========== ======= =========== =========== Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ (0.38) $ 0.00 - $ (0.38) ========== ======= =========== =========== Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ (0.38) $ 0.00 - $ (0.38) ========== ======= =========== =========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,920,990 21,920,990 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,920,990 21,920,990 ========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (5) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 136
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2001 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED AUGUST 31, -------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED(1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED -------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 311,715 $ (904)(2)(5) - $ 310,811 Cost of sales 282,745 (942)(2) $ 5,007(3) 286,810 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Gross profit 28,970 38 (5,007) 24,001 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Operating expenses: Selling 8,018 - - 8,018 General and administrative 12,261 303 (149)(3) 12,415 Warehousing and technical support 5,895 - (4,858)(3) 1,037 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Total operating expenses 26,174 303 (5,007) 21,470 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Operating income (loss) 2,796 (265) - 2,531 Total other income (expense), net (1,283) - - (1,283) ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest 1,513 (265) - 1,248 Provision for (recovery of) income taxes 618 (78)(4) - 540 Minority interest 111 10(6) - 121 ---------- -------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) $ 1,006 $ (177) - $ 829 ========== ======== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ 0.05 $ (0.01) - $ 0.04 ========== ======== ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ 0.05 $ (0.01) - $ 0.04 ========== ======== ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,966,461 21,966,461 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 22,170,039 22,170,039 ========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (6) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 137
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2001 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED NOVEMBER 30, ----------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED(1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED -------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 339,803 $ 1,349(2)(6) - $ 341,152 Cost of sales 317,160 524(2)(5) $ 5,333(3) 323,017 ---------- --------- ---------- ---------- Gross profit 22,643 825 (5,333) 18,135 ---------- --------- ---------- ---------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,628 - - 7,628 General and administrative 12,433 196(5) (148)(3) 12,481 Warehousing and technical support 6,322 - (5,185)(3) 1,137 ----------- --------- ---------- ----------- Total operating expenses 26,383 196 (5,333) 21,246 ---------- --------- ---------- ---------- Operating income (loss) (3,740) 629 - (3,111) Total other income (expense), net (1,282) - - (1,282) ---------- --------- ---------- ---------- Income (loss) before provision for (recovery of) income taxes and minority interest (5,022) 629 - (4,393) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes (1,364) 195(4) - (1,169) Minority interest 140 7(7) - 147 ------------ --------- ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) $ (3,518) $ 441 $ (3,077) ========== ========= ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (basic) $ (0.16) $ 0.02 - $ (0.14) ========== ========= ========== ========== Net income (loss) per common share (diluted) $ (0.16) $ 0.02 - $ (0.14) ========== ========= ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,966,461 21,966,461 ========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,966,461 21,966,461 ========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) and shipping and handling costs (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9 and 00-10, respectively. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c) litigation. (6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (7) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 138
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2002 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED FEBRUARY 28, ----------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED (1) ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 188,597 $ (4,328)(2)(8) - $ 184,269 Cost of sales 170,781 (5,058)(2)(6)(7) $ 4,823 170,546 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Gross profit 17,816 730 (4,823) 13,723 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Operating expenses: Selling 6,754 (3)(2) - 6,751 General and administrative 10,651 542(2)(5)(6) (140)(3) 11,053 Warehousing and technical support 5,846 (21)(2) (4,683)(3) 1,142 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Total operating expenses 23,251 518 (4,823) 18,946 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Operating income (loss) (5,435) 212 - (5,223) Total other income (expense), net (981) (1,350)(5) - (2,331) ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Loss before provision for (recovery of) income taxes, minority interest and before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill (6,416) (1,138) - (7,554) Provision for (recovery of) income taxes (1,670) 170(4) - (1,500) Minority interest 557 - - 557 ------------ ============ ============ ------------ Loss before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill (4,189) (1,308) - (5,497) Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 240 - - 240 ------------ ------------ ============ ------------ Net loss $ (3,949) $ (1,308) - $ (5,257) ============ ============ ============ ============ Net loss per common share (basic) before cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ (0.19) $ (0.06) - $ (0.25) Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 0.01 - - 0.01 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Net loss per common share (basic) $ (0.18) $ (0.06) - $ (0.24) ============ ============ ============ ============ Net loss per common share (diluted) before (0.25) cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill $ (0.19) $ (0.06) - (0.25) Cumulative effect of a change in accounting for negative goodwill 0.01 - - 0.01 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------ Net loss per common share (diluted) $ (0.18) $ (0.06) - $ (0.24) ============ ============ ============ ============ Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,967,263 21,967,263 ============ ============ Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,967,263 21,967,263 ============ ============ Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Includes reclassification of sales incentives (previously reported in operating expenses) pursuant to EITF 01-9. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation. (6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation. (7) Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing. (8) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. 139
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Fiscal 2002 For the Quarter Ended May 31, ---------------------------------------------------------------------- Restatement Reclassification As Reported Adjustments Adjustments As Restated ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 304,603 $ (7,336)(1)(7) - $ 297,267 Cost of sales 280,778 (7,537)(1)(5)(6) $ 5,373(2) 278,614 ----------- --------- ------------ ----------- Gross profit 23,825 201 (5,373) 18,653 ----------- --------- ------------ ----------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,631 (10)(1) - 7,621 General and administrative 15,856 245(1)(4) (148)(2) 15,953 Warehousing and technical support 5,889 (149)(1)(4) (5,225)(2) 515 ----------- --------- ------------ ----------- Total operating expenses 29,376 86 (5,373) 24,089 ----------- --------- ------------ ----------- Operating income (loss) (5,551) 115 - (5,436) Total other income (expense), net 14,843 (1,627)(4)(9) - 13,216 ----------- --------- ----------- ----------- Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest 9,292 (1,512) - 7,780 Provision for income taxes 5,092 (772)(3) - 4,320 Minority interest 255 (42)(8) 213 ----------- --------- ----------- ----------- Net income $ 4,455 $ (782) - $ 3,673 =========== ========= =========== =========== Net income per common share (basic) $ 0.20 $ (0.03) - $ 0.17 =========== ========= =========== =========== Net income per common share (diluted) $ 0.20 $ (0.03) - $ 0.17 =========== ========= =========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,967,263 21,967,263 =========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 22,007,598 22,007,598 =========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation. (6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing. (7) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (8) Amounts reflect adjustments for (g) gain on issuance of subsidiary shares. (9) Amounts reflect impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 140
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2002 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED AUGUST 31, ------------------------------------------------------------------------- RESTATEMENT RECLASSIFICATION AS REPORTED ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENTS AS RESTATED ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net sales $ 291,367 $ 10,625(1)(7) - $ 301,992 Cost of sales 259,791 9,441(1)(5)(6) $ 5,292(2) 274,524 ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Gross profit 31,576 1,184 5,292) 27,468 ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,486 11(1) - 7,497 General and administrative 13,208 (372)(1)(4)(5) (150)(2) 12,686 Warehousing and technical support 6,138 104(1)(4) (5,142)(2) 1,100 ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Total operating expenses 26,832 (257) (5,292) 21,283 ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Operating income (loss) 4,744 1,441 - 6,185 Total other income (expense), net (953) (247)(4) - (1,200) ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Income before provision for income taxes and minority interest 3,791 1,194 - 4,985 Provision for income taxes 2,018 398(3) - 2,416 Minority interest 94 (45)(8) - 49 ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Net income $ 1,867 $ 751 - $ 2,618 ============= =========== =========== ========== Net income per common share (basic) $ 0.09 $ 0.03 - $ 0.12 =========== =========== =========== ========== Net income per common share (diluted) $ 0.08 $ 0.04 - $ 0.12 =========== =========== =========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,947,573 21,947,573 =========== ========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,982,803 21,982,803 =========== ========== Refer to Note (2) for details of restatement adjustments. (1) Amounts reflect adjustments for (b) timing of revenue. (2) Amounts reflect adjustments for (i) operating expense reclassification. (3) Amounts reflect adjustments for (h) income taxes. (4) Amounts reflect adjustments for (d) foreign currency translation. (5) Amounts reflect adjustments for (c)litigation. (6) Amounts reflect adjustments for (e) inventory pricing. (7) Amounts reflect adjustments for (f) sales incentives. (8) Amount reflects impact of the restatement adjustments on minority interest. 141
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED FISCAL 2002 FOR THE QUARTER ENDED NOVEMBER 30, -------------------------- Net sales $ 316,853 Cost of sales 302,098 ----------- Gross profit 14,755 ----------- Operating expenses: Selling 7,639 General and administrative 15,600 Warehousing and technical support 1,117 ----------- Total operating expenses 24,356 ----------- Operating loss (9,601) Total other income (expense), net (1,970) ----------- Loss before provision for income taxes and minority interest (11,571) Provision for income taxes 7,696 Minority interest 4,193 ----------- Net loss $ (15,074) =========== Net loss per common share (basic) $ (0.69) =========== Net loss per common share (diluted) $ (0.69) =========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (basic) 21,809,903 =========== Weighted average number of common shares outstanding (diluted) 21,809,903 =========== (27) Fourth Quarter Adjustments During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2002, the Company recorded the following adjustments to its statement of operations (i) a $13,090 valuation allowance for deferred tax assets that were considered more likely than not to be unrecoverable related to the Wireless segment (note 16); (ii) an inventory obsolescence charge of $7,665 and $2,725 for the Wireless Group and Electronics Group, respectively, relating to inventory (Note 1(f)); (iii) a $1,158 other-than- temporary impairment charge related to investment securities (Note 9); (iv) a $2,091 bad debt reserve related to certain customers whose financial condition and ability to pay their outstanding receivables became doubtful during the fourth quarter; and (v) the reversal of unearned sales incentives of $763 and $947 for the Wireless Group and Electronics Group, respectively. The Company has determined that none of these adjustments relate to prior quarters. (28) Accrued Sales Incentives During the quarter ended May 31, 2002, the Company adopted the provisions of EITF 01-9. 142
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED As a result of adopting EITF 01-9 in 2002, the Company has reclassified co-operative advertising, market development funds and volume incentive rebate costs (collectively sales incentives), which were previously included in selling expenses, to net sales as the Company does not receive an identifiable benefit in connection with these costs. As a result of this reclassification, net sales and selling expenses, after restatement, were reduced by $15,388 and $11,100 for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001, respectively. There was no further impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements as a result of the adoption of EITF 01-9 as the Company's historical accounting policy with respect to the recognition and measure of sales incentives is consistent with EITF 01-9. A summary of the activity with respect to sales incentives for the last three years on a segment and consolidated basis is provided below: Wireless -------- Fiscal Fiscal Fiscal 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Opening balance $ 7,771 $ 11,700 $ 5,209 Accruals 21,240 19,680 31,186 Payments (9,046) (13,616) (25,654) Reversals for unearned incentives (3,197) (7,535) (570) Reversals for unclaimed incentives (5,068) (5,020) (2,646) --------- ---------- ---------- Ending balance $ 11,700 $ 5,209 $ 7,525 ========= ========== ========== Electronics ----------- Fiscal Fiscal Fiscal 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Opening balance $ 3,366 $ 2,894 $ 3,265 Accruals 3,496 5,789 7,665 Payments (2,885) (3,604) (4,804) Reversals for unearned incentives (970) (1,516) (784) Reversals for unclaimed incentives (113) (298) (716) ----------- ----------- ----------- Ending balance $ 2,894 $ 3,265 $ 4,626 ========== ========== ========== 143
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, CONTINUED Consolidated ------------ Fiscal Fiscal Fiscal 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- As Restated As Restated ----------- ----------- Opening balance $ 11,137 $ 14,594 $ 8,474 Accruals 24,736 25,469 38,851 Payments (11,931) (17,220) (30,458) Reversals (9,348) (14,369) (4,716) --------- --------- ---------- Ending balance $ 14,594 $ 8,474 $ 12,151 ========= ========== ========= The majority of the reversals of previously established sales incentive liabilities pertain to sales recorded in prior periods. (29) Subsequent Events In May 2003, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to buy certain assets of Recoton Corporation. In accordance with the agreement, the Company made a deposit of $2,000, which is currently being held in escrow. The Company is awaiting final approval of this purchase from a bankruptcy court. This purchase would amount to approximately $40,000 plus the assumption of $5,000 in debt, not including related acquisition costs. 144
ITEM 9 - CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE None PART III ITEM 10 - DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT SECTION 16(A) BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP REPORTING COMPLIANCE See the information set forth in the section entitled "Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant" in Part I, Item 4(d) of this Form 10-K. Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act requires our executive officers, directors and persons who own more than ten percent of a registered class of our equity securities ("Reporting Persons") to file reports of ownership and changes in ownership on Forms 3, 4 and 5 with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") and the Nasdaq Stock Market (the "Nasdaq"). These Reporting Persons are required by SEC regulation to furnish us with copies of all Form 3, 4 and 5 they file with the SEC and Nasdaq. Based solely upon our review of the copies of the forms it has received, we believe that all Reporting Persons complied on a timely basis with all filing requirements applicable to them with respect to transactions during fiscal 2002. ITEM 11 - EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION The following Summary Compensation Table sets forth the compensation earned by each individual who served as the Company's Chief Executive Officer during fiscal year 2002 and the four other most highly compensated executive officers who were serving as such as of November 30,2002 (collectively, the "Named Officers"). SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE Annual Compensation (1) ----------------------------------------------- All Other Name and Principal Position Year Salary(2) Bonus Compensation(3) - --------------------------- ---- --------- ----- --------------- John J. Shalam President and CEO 2002 450,677 128,669 11,025 2001 450,000 122,000 9,185 2000 450,000 1,273,000 16,616 Philip Christopher Executive Vice President 2002 476,419(4) 1,800,000 2,762 2001 450,000 117,000 8,234 2000 450,000 897,000 8,721 Charles M. Stoehr Senior Vice President and CFO 2002 326,418 242,890 4,253 2001 325,000 41,000 8,234 145
Annual Compensation (1) ----------------------------------------------- All Other Name and Principal Position Year Salary(2) Bonus Compensation(3) - --------------------------- ---- --------- ----- --------------- 2000 325,000 449,000 10,902 Patrick M. Lavelle Senior Vice President 2002 201,277 1,204,508 1,980 2001 200,000 655,636 7,998 2000 200,000 781,365 8,709 Richard A. Maddia Vice President, Information Systems 2002 176,209 37,500 1,213 2001 175,000 65,000 7,409 2000 150,500 52,500 8,313 - ------------- (1) No other annual compensation was paid and no restricted stock awards or options were granted to the named individuals in 2002, 2001 and 2000 and the "Other Annual Compensation", "Restricted Stock" and "Securities Underlying Options" columns have been omitted. (2) For fiscal 2002, salary includes: for Mr. Shalam $677 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; for Mr. Christopher $1,419 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; for Mr. Lavelle $1,277 in 401(k) Company matching contributions; and for Mr. Maddia $709 in 401(k) Company matching contributions. (3) For fiscal 2002, this only includes executive life insurance premiums paid for the benefit of the named executive. (4) Mr. Christopher's base salary for the first six (6) months of fiscal 2002 was $450,000. Effective May 29, 2002, Mr. Christopher's base salary was increased to $500,000 pursuant to an employment agreement (see discussion below under caption "Employment Agreements"). EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS Effective May 29, 2002, Audiovox Communications Corporation ("ACC") entered into an employment agreement with Philip Christopher (the "Agreement"). The Agreement, unless terminated earlier, shall continue until May 29, 2007 and thereafter shall automatically extend by consecutive twelve-month periods unless terminated by ACC on written notice. Pursuant to the Agreement, Mr. Christopher receives a base salary of $500,000, subject to annual Consumer Price Index increases, and an annual bonus equal to two (2%) percent of ACC's annual earnings before income taxes. The Agreement further provides for equity incentives, vesting of stock options, reimbursement of reasonable business expenses and use of an automobile. The Agreement also provided for a bonus pool of $3.2 million, of which Mr. Christopher received $1.8 million (See Bonus disclosure in the Executive Compensation Table). In the event ACC terminates Mr. Christopher's employment without cause or if Mr. Christopher resigns his employment within ninety (90) days after: a significant adverse change in his authority 146
and responsibilities; a reduction in his base salary; nonpayment of his bonus; or a material breach by ACC of any obligation under this Agreement, Mr. Christopher is entitled to receive a separation payment equal to his salary for the remainder of the contract term, plus an average annual bonus plus a cash payment of one million dollars. Mr. Christopher will not be entitled to a separation payment if his employment with ACC is terminated for any reason after the fifth anniversary of the effective date. The Agreement also contains non-competition and non-solicitation covenants that are effective for one year following termination of employment for any reason. OPTION GRANTS IN LAST FISCAL YEAR (2002) No options were granted in the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002. AGGREGATE OPTION EXERCISES IN LAST FISCAL YEAR AND FISCAL YEAR-END OPTION VALUES The following table sets forth information concerning option exercises in fiscal year 2002 and option holdings as of November 30, 2002 with respect to each of the Named Officers. No stock appreciation rights were outstanding at the end of that year. Number of Value* of Securities In-the-money Shares Underlying Options at Acquired Value Options at November 30, Name on Exercise Realized($) November 30, 2002 2002 ---- ------------- ----------- ----------------- ----- Exercisable/ Exercisable/ Unexercisable Unexercisable ------------- ------------- John J. Shalam N/A N/A 525,000/0 $1,945,125/$0 Philip Christopher N/A N/A 1,011,000/0 $1,158,538/$0 Charles M. Stoehr N/A N/A 172,500/0 $ 193,538/$0 Patrick M. Lavelle N/A N/A 245,700/0 $ 217,253/$0 Richard A. Maddia N/A N/A 40,000/0 $ 62,050/$0 - ------------- * Based on the fair market value of the Company's Common Stock at November 30, 2002 less the exercise price payable for such shares. 147
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE PLANS - AWARDS IN LAST FISCAL YEAR Number of Shares, Performance or Other Period Name Units of Other Rights(1) Until Maturation or Payout ---- ------------------------ -------------------------- John J. Shalam 7.1428571364 Units(2) An initial public offering by Audiovox Communications Corp. ("ACC") or an acquisition of a controlling interest in ACC Philip Christopher 7.1428571364 Units(2) An initial public offering by ACC - or the plan termination date, May 28, 2007. Charles M. Stoehr N/A N/A Patrick M. Lavelle N/A N/A Richard A. Maddia N/A N/A - ------------- (1) The awards relate to the Class A Common Stock of Audiovox Communications Corp., (the "Stock") a subsidiary of Audiovox Corporation, which has 146.666666 shares issued and outstanding. Audiovox Corporation owns 75% of those shares. Each unit is equivalent to one share of stock. (2) The value of these appreciation units shall be equivalent to the value of one outstanding share of stock at such time that the performance criteria is achieved. COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS For their service, members of the Board of Directors who are not our salaried employees receive an annual retainer of $15,000 and $500 for each meeting attended. COMPENSATION COMMITTEE REPORT ON EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE COMMITTEE The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors reviews and approves compensation for Audiovox's executive officers and oversees and administers Audiovox's stock option and restricted stock plans. The Compensation Committee recommends compensation for the Chief Executive Officer subject to the Board of Directors approval of such recommendations. The Chief Executive Officer submits recommended compensation levels for other executive officers of Audiovox to the Compensation Committee for its review and approval, subject to applicable employment agreements. Each member of the Compensation Committee is a non-employee Director of Audiovox. The Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors has furnished the following report on executive compensation for fiscal 2002. WHAT IS AUDIOVOX'S PHILOSOPHY OF EXECUTIVE OFFICER COMPENSATION? Our compensation programs are designed to attract and retain talented executives and motivate them to achieve corporate and business objectives that will increase stockholder value. To attain both 148
near and long term corporate goals, it is our policy to provide incentives to senior management and reward outstanding performance and contributions to Audiovox's businesses. Consequently, Audiovox's compensation program for its executives includes a competitive base salary, a performance-based annual bonus and stock-based compensation. This approach to executive compensation enables Audiovox to attract and retain executives of outstanding ability while ensuring that our executives' compensation advances the interests of our shareholders. Consequently, a large proportion of our executives' compensation, the annual bonus, is dependent in significant part on Audiovox's performance. Although Audiovox does not have employment agreements with any of its executive officers, Mr. Philip Christopher's compensation is governed by an employment agreement with Audiovox Communications Corp. BASE SALARY Salaries for the executive officers are designed to attract and retain qualified and dedicated executive officers. Annually, the Committee reviews salary recommendations made by Audiovox's Chief Executive Officer and evaluates individual responsibility levels, experience, performance and length of service. Base salaries for Audiovox's executive officers are fixed at levels commensurate with competitive amounts paid to senior executives with comparable qualifications at companies engaged in the same or similar businesses. ANNUAL BONUS Bonus compensation provides Audiovox with a means of rewarding performance based upon attainment of corporate profitable during the fiscal year. For fiscal 2002, the Compensation Committee established bonus compensation formulas for its executives based upon the pre-tax earnings of the Company. The annual bonus paid to Mr. Lavelle is based upon the achievement of fiscal goals within Audiovox Electronics Corp. Mr. Christopher's annual bonus for fiscal 2002 was paid pursuant to his employment agreement. STOCK OPTIONS During fiscal 2002, no stock options were granted to the Company's employees, including the Company's executive officers. HOW IS THE CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER COMPENSATED? The Compensation Committee has fixed the base salary of the Chief Executive Officer based on competitive compensation data, the Committee's assessment of Mr. Shalam's past performance and its expectation as to his future contributions in guiding and directing Audiovox and its business. Mr. Shalam's 8 bonus for fiscal 2002 was calculated on Audiovox's pre-income tax profit before extraordinary items, other non-recurring transactions and income taxes of the Company in accordance with Audiovox's Executive Officer Bonus Plan that was approved by the shareholders in 2000. HOW IS AUDIOVOX ADDRESSING INTERNAL REVENUE CODE LIMITS ON DEDUCTIBILITY OF COMPENSATION? Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code generally disallows a tax deduction to public corporations for compensation over $1,000,000 paid for any fiscal year to the corporation's chief executive 149
officer and four other most highly compensated executive officers as of the end of any fiscal year. However, the statute exempts qualifying performance-based compensation from the deduction limit if certain requirements are met. The Compensation Committee currently intends to structure performance- based compensation, including stock option grants and annual bonuses, to executive officers who may be subject to Section 162(m) in a manner that satisfies those requirements. The Board and the Compensation Committee reserve the authority to award non-deductible compensation in other circumstances as they deem appropriate. Further, because of ambiguities and uncertainties as to the application and interpretation of Section 162(m) and the regulations issued thereunder, no assurance can be given, notwithstanding the Company's efforts, that compensation intended by the Company to satisfy the requirements for deductibility under Section 162(m) does in fact do so. Members of the Compensation Committee PAUL C. KREUCH, JR. DENNIS F. MCMANUS IRVING HALEVY COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION The Compensation Committee is currently comprised of two independent directors, Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. and Dennis McManus. PERFORMANCE GRAPH COMPARISON OF CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN OF COMPANY, INDUSTRY INDEX AND BROAD MARKET COMPARE 5-YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN AMONG AUDIOVOX CORPORATION, NASDAQ MARKET INDEX AND SIC CODE INDEX [GRAPH OMITTED] 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- AUDIOVOX CORPORATION 100.00 73.05 337.59 109.20 81.82 122.44 SIC CODE INDEX 100.00 75.93 84.07 64.27 64.72 55.98 NASDAQ MARKET INDEX 100.00 123.61 202.45 168.13 125.82 98.47 ASSUMES $100 INVESTED ON NOV. 28, 1997 ASSUMES DIVIDEND REINVESTED FISCAL YEAR ENDING NOV. 30, 2002 The annual changes for the five year period are based on the assumption that $100 had been invested on December 1, 1997, and that all quarterly dividends were reinvested. The total cumulative dollar returns shown on the graph represent the value that such investments would have had on November 30, 2002. ITEM 12 - SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT The following table sets forth, as of May 30, 2003, certain information with respect to shares beneficially owned by (i) each person who is known by the Company to be the beneficial owner of more than five percent (5%) of the Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock, (ii) each of the Company's directors and the executive officers named in the Summary Compensation Table below and (iii) all current directors and executive officers as a group. Beneficial ownership has been determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act. Under this rule, certain shares may be deemed to be beneficially owned by more than one person (if, for example, persons share the power to vote or the power to dispose of the shares). In addition, shares are deemed to be beneficially owned by a person if the person has the right to acquire shares (for example, upon exercise of an option or warrant) within sixty (60) days of the date as of which the information is provided. In computing the percentage ownership of any person, the number of shares is deemed 150
to include the number of shares beneficially owned by such person (and only such person) by reason of such acquisition rights. As a result, the percentage of outstanding shares of any person as shown in the following table does not necessarily reflect the person's actual voting power at any particular date. Sole Voting or Percent of Investment Outstanding Name and Address (1) Power Shares - -------------------- ----- ------ John J. Shalam................................................ 4,590,577(3) 21.7% Philip Christopher............................................ 983,474 4.6% Patrick M. Lavelle............................................ 183,078 * Charles M. Stoehr............................................. 144,549 * Richard Maddia................................................ 37,040 * Ann M. Boutcher............................................... 16,323 * Paul C. Kreuch, Jr............................................ 13,000 * Dennis F. McManus............................................. 11,000 * Irving Halevy................................................. - * Peter Lesser.................................................. - * All directors and officers as a group (10 persons)............ 5,979,041 26.8% Name and Address of Other 5% Holders of Common Stock Dimensional Fund Advisors, Inc. (4)........................... 1,245,721 6.0% 1299 Ocean Ave, 11th Floor Santa Monica, CA 90401 Kahn Brothers & Co., Inc. (5)................................. 1,340,265 6.5% 1299 Ocean Ave, 11th Floor Santa Monica, CA 90401 - ----------- * Represents less than 1% (1) The address of each person, unless otherwise noted, is c/o Audiovox Corporation, 150 Marcus Blvd., Hauppauge, NY 11788. In presents shares beneficially owned and in calculating each holder's percentage ownership, only options exercisable by that person within 60 days of February 1, 2003 and no options exercisable by any other person are deemed to be outstanding. (2) The number of shares stated as "beneficially owned" includes stock options currently exercisable as follows: Mr. Shalam - 525,000, Mr. Christopher - 779,000, Mr. Lavelle - 165,700, Mr. Stoehr - 132,500, Mr. Maddia - 32,000, Ms. Boutcher - 11,000, Mr. Kreuch - 11,000 and Mr. McManus - 11,000. (3) Includes 2,144,152 shares of Class B common stock held by Mr. Shalam that he may convert into Class A common stock at any time. Excludes 116,802 shares of Class B common stock and 2,002 shares of Class A common stock that are held in irrevocable trusts for the benefit of Mr. Shalam's three sons. 151
(4) Information reported is derived from a Schedule 13G dated February 3, 2003 of Dimensional Fund Advisors Inc. and filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 11, 2003. (5) Information reported is derived from a Schedule 13G of Kahn Brothers & Co., Inc. filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 6, 2003. ITEM 13 - CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS TRANSACTIONS WITH MANAGEMENT We lease some of our equipment, office, warehouse and distribution facilities from entities in which our executive officers own controlling interests. The following table identifies leases that result in payments in excess of $60,000 to any of the related entities. RENT PAID DURING REAL PROPERTY FISCAL LOCATION EXPIRATION DATE OWNER OF PROPERTY YEAR 2002 -------- --------------- ----------------- --------- 150 Marcus Blvd. November 30, Hauppauge, NY 2008 150 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC (1) $530,000 16808 Marquardt Avenue Cerritos, CA June 30, 2008 Marquardt Associates (2) 563,399 555 Wireless Blvd. Hauppauge, NY December 1, 2026 Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC (3) 589,340 110 Marcus Blvd. Hauppauge, NY May 31, 2006 110 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC (4) 113,220 EQUIPMENT LOCATION -------- 555 Wireless Blvd. Hauppauge, NY March 31, 2003 Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC (3) 410,640 - ------------- (1) Property owned by 150 Marcus Blvd. Realty LLC, a New York limited liability company, of which John J. Shalam owns 1% and Mr. Shalam's three sons own the remaining 99%. (2) Property owned by Marquardt Associates, a California partnership, owned 60% by John J. Shalam and 40% by Ardama Capital LLC, a New York limited liability company owned by Mr. Shalam's three sons. (3) Property owned or leased by Wireless Blvd. Realty, LLC, a New York limited liability company, owned 98% by the Shalam Long Term Trust, 1% by John J. Shalam and 1% by Mr. Shalam's three sons. The Shalam Long Term Trust is a grantor trust of which Mr. Shalam is the Grantor and his three sons are the beneficiaries. (4) Property owned or leased by 110 Marcus Blvd. Realty, LLC, a Ne York limited liability company, 152
of which John J. Shalam owns 1% and Mr. Shalam's sons own the remaining 99%. We believe that the terms of each of the leases are no less favorable to us than those that could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties. To the extent that conflicts of interest arise between us and such persons in the future, such conflicts will be resolved by a committee of disinterested directors. PART IV ITEM 14 - CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES Within the 90-day period immediately preceding the filing of this Report, the Company's Chief Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer has each evaluated the effectiveness of the Company's "Disclosure Controls and Procedures" and has concluded that they were effective. As such term is used above, the Company's Controls and Procedures are controls and other procedures of the Company that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the Security Exchange Commission's rules and forms. Disclosure Controls and Procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in such reports is accumulated and communicated to the Company's management, including its principal executive officer or officers and principal financial officer or officers, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. There were no significant changes in the Company's internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect such controls subsequent to the date that the Company's Chief Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer conducted their evaluations of the Disclosure Controls and Procedures, including any corrective actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material weaknesses. ITEM 15 - EXHIBITS, CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K (a) (1) The following are included in Item 8 of this Report: Independent Auditors' Report Consolidated Balance Sheets of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002. Consolidated Statements of Operations of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity and Comprehensive Income (Loss) of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows of Audiovox Corporation and Subsidiaries for the Years Ended 153
November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. (a) (2) Financial Statement Schedules of the Registrant for the Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002. Independent Auditors' Report on Financial Statement Schedules Schedule Page Number Description Number ------ ----------- ------ Valuation and Qualifying Accounts 160 II All other financial statement schedules not listed are omitted because they are either not required or the information is otherwise included. 154
Independent Auditors' Report The Board of Directors and Stockholders Audiovox Corporation: Under the date of May 30, 2003 we reported on the consolidated balance sheets of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, which are included in the Company's 2002 annual report on Form 10-K. In connection with our audits of the aforementioned consolidated financial statements, we also audited the related consolidated financial statement schedule in the 2002 annual report on Form 10-K. This consolidated financial statement schedule is the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this consolidated financial statement schedule based on our audits. In our opinion, such consolidated financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein. As discussed in Note 1, effective December 1, 2001, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (Statement) No. 141, "Business Combinations" and Statement No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets". As discussed in Note 2 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements, the consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001 have been restated. /s/ KPMG LLP -------------- KPMG LLP Melville, New York May 30, 2003 155
(3) Exhibits See Item 15(c) for Index of Exhibits. (b) Reports on Form 8-K During the fourth quarter, the Company filed one report on Form 8-K, dated October 21, 2002 and filed on October 22, 2002. The Form 8-K reported that on October 21, 2002, Audiovox Corporation submitted to the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) the Statements under Oath of the Principal Executive Officer and the Principal Financial Officer in accordance with the SEC's June 27, 2002 Order requiring the filing of sworn statements pursuant to Section 21(a)(1) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. (c) Exhibits Exhibit Number Description ------ ----------- 3.1 Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1; No. 33-107, filed May 4, 1987). 3.1a Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1993). 3.1b Amendment to Certificate of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 2000). 3.2 By-laws of the Company (incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1; No. 33-10726, filed May 4, 1987). 10.1 The Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions dated as of July 28, 1999 (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on October 27, 1999). 10.2 First Amendment, dated as of October 13, 1999, to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on October 27, 1999). 10.3 Second Amendment, dated as of December 20, 1999, to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among the Registrant and the several banks and financial institutions (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on January 13, 2000). 10.4 Securities Purchase Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and among Toshiba Corporation, Audiovox Communications Corp. and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 156
Exhibit Number Description ------ ----------- 10.5 Stockholders Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and among Toshiba Corporation, Audiovox Communications Corp. and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.6 Distribution Agreement made and entered into as of May 29, 2002, by and between Toshiba Corporation and Audiovox Communications Corp.(incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.7 Non-Negotiable Subordinated Convertible Promissory Note dated May 31, 2002 by Audiovox Communications Corp. in favor of Toshiba Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.8 Employment Agreement effective as of May 29, 2002 by and among Audiovox Communications Corp., Philip Christopher and Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.9 Trademark License Agreement made as of May 29, 2002 between Audiovox Corporation and Audiovox Communications Corp.(incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.10 Non-Negotiable Demand Note dated May 29, 2002 by Audiovox Communications Corp. in favor of Audiovox Corporation (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.11 Sixth Amendment and Consent, dated as of May 28, 2002 to the Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of July 28, 1999 (as amended) among Audiovox Corporation, the several banks and other financial institutions from time to time parties thereto (collectively the "Lenders") and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as administrative and collateral agent for the Lenders (incorporated by reference to the Company's Form 8-K filed via EDGAR on June 6, 2002). 10.12 Long Term Incentive Compensation Award to John J. Shalam (filed herewith). 10.13 Long Term Incentive Compensation Award to Philip Christopher (filed herewith). 21 Subsidiaries of the Registrant (filed herewith). 23 Independent Auditors' Consent (filed herewith). 99.1 Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith). (d) All other schedules are omitted because the required information is shown in the financial statements or notes thereto or because they are not applicable. 157
SIGNATURES Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. AUDIOVOX CORPORATION June 2, 2003 BY:/s/ /John J. Shalam ----------------------------- John J. Shalam, President and Chief Executive Officer 158
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated. Signature Title Date - --------- ----- ---- President; /s/ John J. Shalam Chief Executive Officer - ------------------ (Principal Executive Officer June 2, 2003 John J. Shalam and Director /s/ Philip Christopher Executive Vice President and - ---------------------- Director June 2, 2003 Philip Christopher Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and June 2, 2003 /s/ Charles M. Stoehr Accounting Officer) and - --------------------- Director Charles M. Stoehr /s/ Patrick M. Lavelle Director June 2, 2003 - ---------------------- Patrick M. Lavelle /s/ Ann Boutcher Director June 2, 2003 - ----------------- Ann Boutcher /s/ Richard A. Maddia Director June 2, 2003 - --------------------- Richard A. Maddia /s/ Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. Director June 2, 2003 - ----------------------- Paul C. Kreuch, Jr. /s/ Dennis McManus Director - ------------------ Dennis McManus June 2, 2003 /s/ Irving Halevy Director - ----------------- Irving Halevy June 2, 2003 159
SCHEDULE II AUDIOVOX CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES Valuation and Qualifying Accounts Years Ended November 30, 2000, 2001 and 2002 (In thousands) Column A Column B Column C Column D Column E -------- --------- --------------------------------- ----------------- -------- Gross Amount Reversals of Balance at Charged to Previously Balance Beginning Costs and Established At End Description Of Year Expenses Accruals Deductions (a) Of Year ----------- --------- --------- ---------- ---------- -------- 2000 - As Restated - ------------------ Allowance for doubtful accounts $ 5,645 $ 2,519 - $ 1,867 $ 6,297 Cash discount allowances 219 - - 24 195 Accrued sales incentives 11,137 24,736 $ (9,348) 11,931 14,594 Allowance for cellular deactivations 1,261 - - 7 1,254 Reserve for warranties and product repair costs 7,771 8,256 - 3,653 12,374 ------- ------- --------- --------- ------- $26,033 $35,511 $ (9,348) $ 17,482 $34,714 ======= ======= ========== ========= ======= 2001 - As Restated - ------------------ Allowance for doubtful accounts $ 6,297 $ 1,936 - $ 3,518 $ 4,715 Cash discount allowances 195 - - 13 182 Accrued sales incentives 14,594 25,469 $ (14,369) 17,220 8,474 Allowance for cellular deactivations 1,254 - - (781) 2,035 Reserve for warranties and product repair costs 12,374 11,319 - 10,627 13,066 ------- ------- --------- --------- ------- $34,714 $38,724 $ (14,369) $ 30,597 $28,472 ======= ======= ========= ========= ======= 2002 - ---- Allowance for doubtful accounts $ 4,715 $ 4,884 - $ 2,770 $ 6,829 Cash discount allowances 182 - - (25) 207 Accrued sales incentives 8,474 38,851 $ (4,716) 30,458 12,151 Allowance for cellular deactivations 2,035 - - 407 1,628 Reserve for warranties and product repair costs 13,066 6,985 - 4,641 15,410 ------- ------- --------- --------- ------- $28,472 $50,720 $ (4,716) $ 38,251 $36,225 ======= ======= ========== ========= ======= (a) For the allowance for doubtful accounts, cash discount allowances and accrued sales incentives, deductions represent payments made or credits issued to customers. For the allowance for cellular deactivations, deductions represent credits taken against accounts receivable by carrier customers for deactivations of previously activated wireless customers. For the reserve for warranties and product repair costs, deductions represent payments for labor and parts made to service centers and vendors for the repair of units returned under warranty. 160
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 I, John J. Shalam, certify that: 1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Audiovox Corporation; 2. Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this annual report; and 3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this annual report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this annual report. 4. The registrant's other certifying officers and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have: (a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared; (b) evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures as of a date within 90 days prior to the filing date of this annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and, (c) presented in this annual report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures based on our evaluation as of the Evaluation Date; 5. The registrant's other certifying officers and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's board of directors: (a) all significant deficiencies in the design or operation of internal controls which could adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial date and have identified for the registrant's auditors any material weaknesses in internal controls; and (b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal controls; and 6. The registrant's other certifying officers and I have indicated in this annual report whether there were significant changes in internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material weaknesses. Date: June 2, 2003 /s/ John J. Shalam - ------------------------------------ John J. Shalam, Chief Executive Officer 161
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 I, Charles M. Stoehr, certify that: 1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Audiovox Corporation; 2. Based on my knowledge, this annual report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this annual report; and 3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this annual report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this annual report. 4. The registrant's other certifying officers and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-14 and 15d-14) for the registrant and have: (a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared; (b) evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures as of a date within 90 days prior to the filing date of this annual report (the "Evaluation Date"); and, (c) presented in this annual report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures based on our evaluation as of the Evaluation Date; 5. The registrant's other certifying officers and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of registrant's board of directors: (a) all significant deficiencies in the design or operation of internal controls which could adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial date and have identified for the registrant's auditors any material weaknesses in internal controls; and (b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal controls; and 6. The registrant's other certifying officers and I have indicated in this annual report whether there were significant changes in internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent to the date of our most recent evaluation, including any corrective actions with regard to significant deficiencies and material weaknesses. Date: June 2, 2003 /s/ Charles M. Stoehr - ----------------------------------------- Charles M. Stoehr Chief Financial Officer 162
AUDIOVOX CORPORATION LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION AWARD TO JOHN J. SHALAM DATED AS OF MAY 29, 2002 1. Purpose. The purpose of this Audiovox Corporation Long-Term Incentive Compensation Award (the "Award") is to align the interests of John J. Shalam, as President and CEO of Audiovox Corporation, a Delaware corporation (together with its successors, "AX"), and its subsidiaries (and their respective successors), now held or hereafter acquired with those of the equity holders of AX; to motivate and to reward the performance of John J. Shalam in fulfilling his personal responsibilities with regard to Audiovox Communications Corp. ("ACC") and its subsidiaries (and their respective successors) for long-range achievements. 2. Administration. This Award shall be administered by the Board. The Board shall have the authority, in its sole discretion, subject to and not inconsistent with the express provisions of this Award, to administer this Award and to exercise all the powers and authorities either specifically granted to it under this Award or necessary or advisable in connection with the administration of this Award; to construe and interpret this Award; to prescribe, amend and rescind rules and regulations relating to this Award; and to make all other determinations deemed necessary or advisable for the administration of this Award, consistent with the terms and provisions of this Award. Determinations made by the Board pursuant to this Section 2 shall be final and binding on AX, its subsidiaries and their respective successors and John J. Shalam. 3. Appreciation Units. (a) Initial Number and Value of Units. The current total number of issued and outstanding shares of Stock of ACC is 146.666666. Based on a value of $773,818, the aggregate number of Appreciation Units which are subject to this Award is 7.1428571364, subject to adjustment as provided in paragraph (b) below. For illustration purposes only, assuming a future stock split of 22 Million shares, this Award would be equal to 1,000,000 shares at $5.53 per share. Assuming an IPO price of $20.53 per share, the Appreciation Value would be equal to $15,000,000.00. The value at any time of an Appreciation Unit shall be equivalent to the value of one outstanding share of Stock at such time. The Board shall determine in its discretion, subject to the terms of this Award, the Final Value of an Appreciation Unit. (b) Equitable Adjustment. Subject to Section 4, in the event that a transaction or other event or circumstance affecting ACC is proposed or shall occur, including, but not limited to, Exhibit 10.12
(i) equity investments in ACC or distributions from ACC in respect of equity interests in ACC (whether such investments or distributions are made in cash or in kind) or (ii) any dividend or other distribution (whether in the form of cash, stock or other property), recapitalization, stock split, reverse stock split, reorganization, tender offer, merger, consolidation, spin-off, combination, repurchase, share exchange, sale of assets or other similar transaction or event, and the Board determines, in its sole discretion, that a change or adjustment in the terms of any Award is appropriate, then the Board may, in its sole discretion, make such equitable changes or adjustments or take any other actions that it deems necessary or appropriate (which shall be effective at such time as the Board in its sole discretion determines), including, but not limited to causing changes or adjustments to any or all of (i) the number of any Appreciation Units subject to an outstanding Award and (ii) the Base Value associated with any Appreciation Units subject to an outstanding Award. (c) Rights with Respect to the Appreciation Units. Each Appreciation Unit represents the right to receive: (i) in the event that the Triggering Event is an IPO, the right to receive an Option as provided under Section 4; or (ii) in the event that the Triggering Event is the closing of any Acquisition of a Controlling Interest in ACC by Toshiba or another third party, an amount ("Appreciation Unit Payment Amount") equal to the excess, if any, of the price per share over the Base Value of Appreciation Unit. Payment of the Appreciation Unit Payment Amount in case (ii) shall be made in the form of cash. (d) Vesting of Appreciation Units. This Award of Appreciation Units granted to John J. Shalam is vested. The Appreciation Units can be sold, assigned, transferred, pledged, hypothecated or otherwise disposed of by the Participant. 4. IPO Triggering Event. In the event there shall occur an IPO, then, upon the IPO Date, this Award shall be canceled and John J. Shalam shall be entitled to receive from AX an Option to purchase shares of Stock. Each Option so granted shall be subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Board in its sole discretion at the time of grant of such Option including without limitation those decisions necessary or desirable to effect a successful conclusion of the IPO; provided, however, that the aggregate Appreciation Value of the Appreciation Unit Award as of the IPO Date shall be preserved as of the grant date of such Option and such Option shall continue for at least ten (10) years. 5. General Provisions. (a) Compliance with Legal Requirements. This Award, and the other obligations of AX under this Award shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental authority or agency as may be required. (b) Withholding Taxes. At the time AX makes any payment relating to any Appreciation Unit, AX may withhold from such payment the full amount of any federal and state withholding or other employment taxes required by any government authority to be withheld or Exhibit 10.12
otherwise deducted and paid in respect of such payment. The Board may provide for other arrangements to satisfy AX's withholding obligations in this Award or otherwise. (c) Amendment and Termination of this Award. This Award shall automatically terminate upon the occurrence of a Triggering Event. (d) Unfunded Status of Awards. This Award is intended to constitute an "unfunded" Award for incentive and deferred compensation. With respect to any payments not yet made to John J. Shalam pursuant to this Award, nothing contained in this Award shall give John J. Shalam any rights that are greater than those of a general creditor of AX. (e) Governing Law. This Award and all determinations made and actions taken pursuant hereto shall be governed by the laws of the State of Delaware without giving effect to the conflict of laws principles thereof. (f) Effective Date. The Board has adopted this Award. This Award shall become effective as of the Effective Date. 6. Definitions. The following terms shall have the following meanings: (a) "Acquisition" shall mean any transaction involving a transfer (whether by way of merger, sale, gift, other business combination or otherwise). (b) "Appreciation Unit" shall mean a unit granted pursuant to the terms of this Award, having the rights provided for herein and in such Award. (c) "Appreciation Unit Payment Amount" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(c). (d) "Appreciation Value" associated with an Award shall mean the product derived by multiplying (i) the excess, if any, of (A) the Final Value of each Appreciation Unit subject thereto on the date on which such Appreciation Unit is canceled, less (B) the Base Value associated with each such Appreciation Unit, and (ii) the number of Appreciation Units (including fractions thereof) subject to such Award. (e) "Base Value" shall mean with respect to each Appreciation Unit made subject to an Initial Award, $773,818.19 subject to adjustment as provided under Section 3(b). (f) "Board" shall mean the Board of Directors of AX. (g) "Consolidated Interest Expense" shall mean, for any period, the sum of, without duplication: (i) the aggregate of the interest expense for such period; and (ii) the interest component of capitalized lease Obligations paid, accrued and/or scheduled Exhibit 10.12
to be paid or accrued during such period, in each case, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP. (h) "Consolidated Net Income" shall mean, for any period, the aggregate net income (or loss) of ACC for such period on a consolidated basis, determined in accordance with GAAP; provided, however, that there shall be excluded therefrom (i) after-tax gains or losses from asset sales or abandonments or reserves relating thereto, (ii) after-tax items classified as extraordinary or nonrecurring gains and (iii) income or loss attributable to discontinued operations (including, without limitation, operations disposed of during such period whether or not such operations were classified as discontinued). (i) "Controlling Interest" shall mean beneficial ownership, directly or indirectly, of securities of ACC representing more than 50% of the voting power of ACC's then outstanding securities. (j) "Debt" shall mean, without duplication: (i) all Obligations for borrowed money; (ii) all Obligations evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes or other similar instruments; (iii) all capitalized lease Obligations; (iv) all Obligations issued or assumed as the deferred purchase price of property, all conditional sale obligations and all Obligations under any title retention agreement (but excluding trade accounts payable and other accrued liabilities arising in the ordinary course of business that are not overdue by 90 days or more or are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted); (v) all Obligations for the reimbursement of any obligor on any letter of credit, banker's acceptance or similar credit transaction; (vi) guarantees and other contingent Obligations in respect of Debt referred to in clauses (i) through (v) above and clause (viii) below; (vii) all Obligations of the type referred to in clauses (i) through (vi) above which are secured by any lien on any property or asset, the amount of such Obligation being deemed to be the lesser of the fair market value of such property or asset or the amount of the Obligation so secured; and (viii) all Obligations under currency agreements and interest swap agreements of ACC. For purposes of this definition, the amount outstanding at any time of any Debt with original issue discount is the face amount of such Debt less the remaining unamortized portion of the original issue discount of such Debt at such time as determined in accordance with GAAP. (k) "Effective Date" shall mean May 29, 2002. (l) "Final Value" shall mean, with respect to an Appreciation Unit: (i) in the event the Triggering Event is an IPO, the initial offering price of a share of Stock, as determined by ACC's underwriters in connection with such IPO; or (ii) in the event of an Acquisition of a controlling interest in ACC by Toshiba or another third party, Exhibit 10.12
the price at which each share of Stock is acquired by Toshiba or such other third party. (m) "GAAP" shall mean U.S. generally acceptable accounting principles. (n) "IPO" shall mean the initial public offering by ACC of shares of Stock registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. (o) "IPO Date" shall mean the date on which the IPO becomes effective. (p) "Obligations" shall mean all obligations for principal, premium, interests, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any Debt. (q) "Option" shall mean a non-qualified stock option that is granted in accordance with the terms of Section 4. (r) "Stock" shall mean the Class A Common Stock of ACC, no par value per share. (s) "Triggering Event" shall mean the earlier to occur of (i) the IPO Date and (ii) the closing of any Acquisition of a Controlling Interest in ACC by Toshiba or another third party. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, John J. Shalam and Audiovox Corporation have executed this Award as of May 29, 2002. AUDIOVOX CORPORATION By: /s/ Charles M. Stoehr ------------------ Charles M. Stoehr /s/ John J. Shalam ------------------ John J. Shalam Exhibit 10.12
AUDIOVOX COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN AWARD AGREEMENT This Award Agreement (this "Award Agreement") evidencing the grant of an Award pursuant to the terms of the Audiovox Communications Corporation Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the "Plan"), is entered into between Audiovox Communications Corporation ("ACC") and Philip Christopher (the "Participant"). 1. Date of Award: June 1, 2002. 2. Number of Appreciation Units Subject to Award: 7.1428571364, which assuming a future stock split of 22 Million shares will be equal to 1,000,000 shares at $5.53 per share. 3. Vesting: The Award has vested in accordance with and i governed by Sections 5 and 7 of the employment agreement between Philip Christopher and Audiovox Communications Corporation dated as of May 29, 2002. 4. The Plan is incorporated herein by reference and made a part hereof, and the Appreciation Units granted hereby and this Award Agreement are subject to all terms and conditions of the Plan. In the event of any inconsistency or conflict between the terms of the Plan and the provisions of this Award Agreement, the terms of the Plan shall control. Capitalized terms used herein which are not specifically defined herein shall have the meanings given them in the Plan. 5. Participant acknowledges receipt of a copy of the Plan. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Award Agreement as of the Date set forth first above: AUDIOVOX COMMUNICATIONS CORP. /s/ Charles M. Stoehr ------------------------------ By: Charles M. Stoehr Title: Vice President /s/ Philip Christopher ------------------------------ Philip Christopher 555 Wireless Blvd. Exhibit 10.13
Hauppauge, NY 11788 AUDIOVOX COMMUNICATIONS CORP. LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN 1. Purpose. The purpose of the Audiovox Communications Corp. Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the "Plan") is to align the interests of employees, non-employee directors and consultants of Audiovox Communications Corp., a Delaware corporation (together with its successors, "ACC"), and its subsidiaries (and their respective successors), now held or hereafter acquired with those of the equity holders of ACC; to attract, motivate and retain the best available executive personnel, employees, non-employee directors and consultants of ACC; and to reward the performance of such individuals in fulfilling their personal responsibilities for long-range achievements. 2. Definitions. (a) "ACC" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 1. (b) "Affiliate" shall mean a company that is a parent of, under the control of, or under common control with, ACC. (c) "Appreciation Unit" shall mean a unit granted pursuant to the terms of the Plan and an Award Agreement, having the rights provided for herein and in such Award Agreement. (d) "Appreciation Unit Payment Amount" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(c). (e) "Appreciation Value" associated with an Award shall mean the product derived by multiplying (i) the excess, if any, of (A) the Final Value of each Appreciation Unit subject thereto on the date on which such Appreciation Unit is cancelled, less (B) the Base Value associated with each such Appreciation Unit, and (ii) the number of Appreciation Units (including fractions thereof) subject to such Award. (f) "Award" shall mean the grant of an Appreciation Unit granted to a Participant pursuant to an Award Agreement under the Plan. (g) "Award Agreement" shall mean any written agreement, contract or other instrument or document between ACC and a Participant evidencing an Award; each Award Agreement shall set forth, among other things, the number of Appreciation Units Exhibit 10.13
granted pursuant thereto, the vesting schedule, if any, applicable to such Appreciation Units and the Base Value associated with such Appreciation Units. (h) "Base Value" shall mean: (i) with respect to each Appreciation Unit made subject to an Initial Award, $773,818.19; and (ii) with respect to each Appreciation Unit made subject to an Award that is not an Initial Award, the value of a share of Stock as of the date of grant, as determined in good faith by the Board; provided, that, in any case, the Base Value of any Appreciation Unit may be subject to adjustment as provided under Section 5(b). (i) "Board" shall mean the Board of Directors of ACC. (j) "Consolidated Interest Expense" shall mean, for any period, the sum of, without duplication: (i) the aggregate of the interest expense for such period; and (ii) the interest component of capitalized lease Obligations paid, accrued and/or scheduled to be paid or accrued during such period, in each case, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP. (k) "Consolidated Net Income" shall mean, for any period, the aggregate net income (or loss) of ACC for such period on a consolidated basis, determined in accordance with GAAP; provided, however, that there shall be excluded therefrom (i) after-tax gains or losses from asset sales or abandonments or reserves relating thereto, (ii) after-tax items classified as extraordinary or nonrecurring gains and (iii) income or loss attributable to discontinued operations (including, without limitation, operations disposed of during such period whether or not such operations were classified as discontinued). (l) "Debt" shall mean, without duplication: (i) all Obligations for borrowed money; (ii) all Obligations evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes or other similar instruments; (iii) all capitalized lease Obligations; (iv) all Obligations issued or assumed as the deferred purchase price of property, all conditional sale obligations and all Obligations under any title retention agreement (but excluding trade accounts payable and other accrued liabilities arising in the ordinary course of business that are not overdue by 90 days or more or are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted); (v) all Obligations for the reimbursement of any obligor on any letter of credit, banker's acceptance or similar credit transaction; (vi) guarantees and other contingent Obligations in respect of Debt referred to in clauses (i) through (v) above and clause (viii) below; (vii) all Obligations of the type referred to in clauses (i) through (vi) above which are secured by any lien on any property or asset, the amount of such Obligation being deemed to be the lesser of the fair market value of such property or asset or the amount of the Obligation so secured; and (viii) all Obligations under currency agreements and interest swap agreements of ACC. For purposes of this definition, the amount outstanding at any time of any Debt with original issue discount is the face amount Exhibit 10.13
of such Debt less the remaining unamortized portion of the original issue discount of such Debt at such time as determined in accordance with GAAP. (m) "EBITDA" shall mean, for any period, the sum (without duplication) of: (i) Consolidated Net Income; and (ii) to the extent Consolidated Net Income has been reduced thereby, (A) all income taxes of ACC paid or accrued in accordance with GAAP for such period (other than income taxes attributable to extraordinary, unusual or nonrecurring gains or losses or taxes attributable to sales or dispositions outside the ordinary course of business), (B) Consolidated Interest Expense and (C) non-cash charges less any non-cash items increasing Consolidated Net Income for such period, all as determined on a consolidated basis for ACC in accordance with GAAP. (n) "Effective Date" shall mean May 29, 2002. (o) "Final Value" shall mean, with respect to any Appreciation Unit: (i) in the event the Triggering Event is an IPO, the initial offering price of a share of Stock, as determined by ACC's underwriters in connection with such IPO; or (ii) in the event that no IPO occurs prior to the Plan Termination Date, the result obtained by (A) multiplying (1) average EBITDA for the four most recently completed fiscal years ending prior to the Termination Date by (2) the number 6.5, and (B) subtracting from the product thereof Debt (calculated as of the Termination Date). (p) "GAAP" shall mean U.S. generally acceptable accounting principles. (q) "Initial Award" shall mean an Award granted pursuant to the initial allocation by the CEO of Appreciation Units, as provided under Section 3. (r) "IPO" shall mean the initial public offering by ACC of shares of Stock registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. (s) "IPO Date" shall mean the date on which the IPO becomes effective. (t) "Obligations" shall mean all obligations for principal, premium, interests, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any Debt. (u) "Option" shall mean a non-qualified stock option that is granted in accordance with the terms of Section 6. (v) "Participant" shall mean any officer or other employee, non-employee director or consultant of ACC or any of its subsidiaries who receives an Award under the Plan. (w) "Plan" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 1. (x) "Plan Termination Date" shall mean the fifth anniversary of the Effective Date. Exhibit 10.13
(y) "Stock" shall mean the Class A Common Stock of ACC, no par value per share. (z) "Triggering Event" shall mean the earlier to occur of (i) the IPO Date and (ii) the Plan Termination Date. 3. Administration. The Plan shall be administered by the Board. The Board shall have the authority, in its sole discretion, subject to and not inconsistent with the express provisions of the Plan, to administer the Plan and to exercise all the powers and authorities either specifically granted to it under the Plan or necessary or advisable in connection with the administration of the Plan, including, without limitation, the authority to grant Awards; to determine the persons to whom and the time or times at which Awards shall be granted; to determine the number of Appreciation Units to be granted to any Participant, and the terms, conditions, restrictions and performance criteria relating to any Award; to determine whether, to what extent and under what circumstances an Award may be settled, cancelled, adjusted, forfeited, exchanged, surrendered or accelerated; to construe and interpret the Plan and any Award; to prescribe, amend and rescind rules and regulations relating to the Plan; to determine the terms and provisions of Award Agreements, consistent with the terms and provisions of the Plan; and to make all other determinations deemed necessary or advisable for the administration of the Plan, consistent with the terms and provisions of the Plan. Determinations made by the Board pursuant to this Section 3 shall be final and binding on ACC, its subsidiaries and their respective successors and the Participants. Notwithstanding the foregoing, ACC's Chief Executive Officer as of the Effective Date (the "CEO") shall have the discretion to determine the initial allocation of Appreciation Units under the Plan as follows: the CEO shall have sole discretion to determine the initial allocation of the remaining Appreciation Units initially reserved under the Plan, provided that at least 54.55% must be allocated to individuals other than the CEO and the Board shall have the right to review these allocations made by the CEO and make changes to such allocations as it, in its sole discretion, shall determine to be appropriate. 4. Eligibility. Initial Awards may be granted by ACC to the CEO and such other employees, non- employee directors and consultants of ACC and its subsidiaries as the CEO shall determine in his sole discretion, subject to the provisions of Section 3. Awards under the Plan that are not Initial Awards may be granted by ACC to such employees, non-employee directors and consultants of ACC and its subsidiaries as the Board shall determine in its sole discretion, subject to the provisions of Section 3. 5. Appreciation Units. (a) Initial Number and Value of Units. The aggregate number of Appreciation Units which may be made subject to Initial Awards is 15.7142857, subject to adjustment as provided in paragraph (b) below. The value at any time of an Appreciation Unit shall be equivalent to the value of one outstanding share of Stock at such time. Each grant of Appreciation Unit subject to an Award Exhibit 10.13
shall be evidenced by an Award Agreement in such form and having such terms and conditions as the Board shall from time to time approve. The Board shall determine in its discretion, subject to the terms of the Plan, the Final Value of any Appreciation Unit, and the vesting schedule, if any, applicable to each Award, and the performance criteria, if any, which must be attained as a condition of such vesting. The Board shall also determine in its discretion the Base Value of any Appreciation Unit that may be made subject to an Award that is not an Initial Award. Any Appreciation Unit that is subject to an Award that is forfeited and cancelled prior to a Triggering Event shall be available for re-issuance under the Plan. (b) Equitable Adjustment. Subject to Section 6, in the event that a transaction or other event or circumstance affecting ACC is proposed or shall occur, including, but not limited to, (i) equity investments in ACC or distributions from ACC in respect of equity interests in ACC (whether such investments or distributions are made in cash or in kind) or (ii) any dividend or other distribution (whether in the form of cash, stock or other property), recapitalization, stock split, reverse stock split, reorganization, tender offer, merger, consolidation, spin-off, combination, repurchase, share exchange, sale of assets or other similar transaction or event, and the Board determines, in its sole discretion, that a change or adjustment in the terms of any Award is appropriate, then the Board may, in its sole discretion, make such equitable changes or adjustments or take any other actions that it deems necessary or appropriate (which shall be effective at such time as the Board in its sole discretion determines), including, but not limited to causing changes or adjustments to any or all of (i) the number of, and vesting schedule applicable to, any Appreciation Units subject to an outstanding Award, (ii) the Base Value associated with any Appreciation Units subject to an outstanding Award and (iii) the number of Appreciation Units remaining available for grants of Awards. (c) Rights with Respect to Appreciation Units. Each vested Appreciation Unit shall represent the right to receive, subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan and the Award Agreement pursuant to which such Appreciation Unit is granted: (i) in the event that the Triggering Event is an IPO, the right to receive an Option as provided under Section 6; or (ii) in the event that the Triggering Event is the occurrence of the Plan Termination Date, an amount ("Appreciation Unit Payment Amount") equal to the excess, if any, of the Final Value of the Appreciation Unit over the Base Value of such Appreciation Unit. Payment of the Appreciation Unit Payment Amount shall be made in the form of cash. (d) Vesting of Appreciation Units. Unless otherwise provided in an Award Agreement at the time of grant of such Award, and subject to the conditions set forth in this Plan, no Award of Appreciation Units granted to a Participant shall become vested until the occurrence of a Triggering Event, at which time all outstanding Awards shall vest in full. (e) Termination of Services. Unless otherwise set forth in an Award Agreement at the time of grant of such Award, if a Participant ceases to provide services to ACC for any reason (whether voluntarily, involuntarily or by death), then, all Appreciation Units held by such Participant shall be immediately forfeited and cancelled effective as of the effective date of the termination of such Participant's services. Exhibit 10.13
(f) Restrictions. Appreciation Units cannot be sold, assigned, transferred, pledged, hypothecated or otherwise disposed of by the Participant. Any attempt to so dispose of all or any portion of an Appreciation Unit shall be void and without any force and effect. 6. IPO Triggering Event. In the event that during the term of the Plan there shall occur an IPO, then, upon the IPO Date, each then-outstanding Award shall be cancelled and the holder thereof shall be entitled to receive from ACC a grant of an Option that shall be granted by ACC subject to the terms of any of its then-extant equity incentive plans that provides for the grant of non- qualified stock options to purchase shares of Stock (any such plan, an "ACC Plan"). Each Option so granted shall be subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Board in its sole discretion at the time of grant of such Option, not inconsistent with the terms of such ACC Plan; provided, however, that the aggregate Appreciation Value of the Appreciation Unit Award as of the IPO Date shall be preserved as of the grant date of such Option. 7. General Provisions. (a) Compliance with Legal Requirements. The Plan and the granting of, and payments with respect to, Awards, and the other obligations of ACC under the Plan and any Award Agreement or other agreement shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations and to such approvals by any regulatory or governmental authority or agency as may be required. (b) No Right To Provide Services. Nothing in the Plan or in any Award granted or any Award Agreement or other agreement entered into pursuant hereto shall confer upon any Participant the right to continue to provide services to ACC or to be entitled to any remuneration or benefits not set forth in the Plan or such Award Agreement or other agreement or to interfere with or limit in any way the right of ACC to terminate such Participant's services. (c) Withholding Taxes. At the time ACC makes any payment relating to any Appreciation Unit, ACC may withhold from such payment the full amount of any federal and state withholding or other employment taxes required by any government authority to be withheld or otherwise deducted and paid in respect of such payment. The Board may provide for other arrangements to satisfy ACC's withholding obligations in the Award Agreement or otherwise. (d) Amendment and Termination of the Plan. The Board may at any time and from time to time alter, amend, suspend or terminate the Plan in whole or in part; provided, however, that no amendment which requires the approval of ACC's equity holders under applicable Delaware law shall be effective unless the same shall be approved by the requisite vote. Notwithstanding the foregoing, subject to the other provisions of the Plan and the applicable Award Agreement, no amendment shall affect adversely any of the rights of any Participant, without such Participant's consent, under any Award theretofore granted under the Plan. The Plan and the power to grant Awards under the Plan shall automatically terminate upon the occurrence of a Triggering Event. If the Plan is terminated, any outstanding Award shall continue to be administered in accordance with its terms and the terms of the Plan in effect immediately prior to such termination. Exhibit 10.13
(e) Participant Rights. No Participant shall have any claim to be granted any Award under the Plan, and there is no obligation for uniformity of treatment for Participants. The Participant shall not have any rights as an equity holder of ACC with respect to any Appreciation Units. (f) Unfunded Status of Awards. The Plan is intended to constitute an "unfunded" plan for incentive and deferred compensation. With respect to any payments not yet made to a Participant pursuant to an Award, nothing contained in the Plan or any Award shall give any such Participant any rights that are greater than those of a general creditor of ACC. (g) Governing Law. The Plan and all determinations made and actions taken pursuant hereto shall be governed by the laws of the State of Delaware without giving effect to the conflict of laws principles thereof. (h) Effective Date. The Board has adopted the Plan. The Plan shall become effective as of the Effective Date. Exhibit 10.13
SUBSIDIARIES OF REGISTRANT Jurisdiction of Subsidiaries Incorporation - ------------ ------------- Audiovox Communications Corp. Delaware Audiovox Electronics Corporation Delaware Quintex Mobile Communications Corp. Delaware American Radio Corp. Georgia Audiovox Holding Corp. New York Audiovox Canada Limited Ontario Audiovox Communications (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd. Malaysia Audiovox Holdings (M) Sdn. Bhd. Malaysia Audiovox Venezuela C.A. Venezuela Exhibit 21
Independent Auditors' Consent ----------------------------- The Board of Directors and Stockholders Audiovox Corporation: We consent to the incorporation by reference in registration statement Nos. 333-36762 and 333- 82073 on Form S-8 of Audiovox Corporation of our report dated June 1, 2003, with respect to the consolidated balance sheets of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2001 and 2002, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended November 30, 2002, and the related financial statement schedule, which report appears in the November 30, 2002 annual report on Form 10-K of Audiovox Corporation and subsidiaries. Our report dated June 1, 2003 contains explanatory paragraphs that state that the Company: o Changed its method of accounting for goodwill and other intangible assets and retroactively reclassified the consolidated statements of operations for 2000 and 2001. o Has restated the consolidated balance sheet as of November 30, 2001 and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for the years ended November 30, 2000 and 2001. s/KPMG LLP -------------------------------- KPMG LLP Melville, New York June 1, 2003 Exhibit 23
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18U.S.C. SECTION 1350, AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended November 30, 2002 (the "Report") of Audiovox Corporation (the "Company"), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof, I, John J. Shalam, the Chief Executive Officer of the Company certify, to the best of my knowledge, that: (1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and (2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. s/ John J. Shalam - ------------------------------------- John J. Shalam President and Chief Executive Officer June 2, 2003 Exhibit 99.1
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18U.S.C. SECTION 1350, AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended November 30, 2002 (the "Report") of Audiovox Corporation (the "Company"), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof, I, Charles M. Stoehr, the Chief Financial Officer of the Company certify, to the best of my knowledge, that: (1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and (2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. s/ Charles M. Stoehr - -------------------------------- Charles M. Stoehr Chief Financial Officer June 2, 2003 Exhibit 99.1